Advances in Geophisycs, H. E. Landsberg, 1974
Advances in Geophisycs, H. E. Landsberg, 1974
Advances in Geophisycs, H. E. Landsberg, 1974
GEOPHYSICS
VOLUME 17
Contributors to This Volume
FRANS DEMEYER
FRANCIS E. FENDELL
V. B. KOMAROV
A. QUINET
B. V. SHILTN
Advances in
GEOPHYSICS
Edited by
H. E. LANDSBERG
lnstitute for Fluid Dynamics and Applied Mothematics
University of Maryland, College Park, Maryland
J. VAN MIEGHEM
Royal Belgian Meteorological lnstitute
Uccle, Belgium
VOLUME 17
I974
LIBRARY
OF CONGRESS
CATALOG
CARDNUMBER:
52-12266
ISBN 0-12-018817-1
Tropical Cyclones
FRANCIS
E . FENDELL
1. Introduction ................................................ 2
2 . Aspects of Tropical Meteorology ............................... 17
3 . Models of a Mature Tropical Cyclone ........................... 29
4 . Theory of Tropical Cyclone Intensification ...................... 75
5 . Concluding Remarks ......................................... 86
Appendix A . Estimating the Kinetic Energy and Water Content
of Hurricanes ............................................... 87
Appendix B. The Moist Adiabat ................................. 88
Partial List of Symbols ......................................... 92
References .................................................... 93
Note Added in Proof ........................................... 100
SUBJECT ................................................
INDEX 323
LIST OF CONTRIBUTORS
Numbers in parentheses indicate the pages on which the authors' contributions begin.
FRANS
DEMEYER,Royal Belgian Meteorological Institute, Uccle, Belgium (187)
FRANCISE. FENDELL, Engineering Sciences Laboratory, T R W S y s t e m Group,
Redondo Beach, California (1)
V. B. KOMAROV,
Laboratory of Aeromethods, Ministry of Geology, Leningrad,
U.S.S.R. (263)
A. QUINET,Institut Royal Me'te'orologiquede Belgique, Bruxelles, Belgium (101)
B. V. SHILI", Laboratory of Aeromethods, Ministry of Geology, Leningrad,
U . S . S . R .(263)
vii
This Page Intentionally Left Blank
TROPICAL CYCLONES
Francis E. Fendell
Engineering Sciences Laboratory
TRW Systems Group. Redondo Beach. California
.
1 Introduction .......................................................... 2
1.1. The Dangers and Benefits of Hurricanes ............................. 2
1.2. Some Observational Facts on Hurricanes ............................. 8
1.3. Tropical Cyclone Generation ....................................... 3
1.4. Properties of Mature Hurricanes .................................... 5
1.5. Path Prediction ................................................... 12
1.6. The Importance of Tropical Cyclones in the Global Circulation . . . . . . . . . . 13
2. Aspects of Tropical Meteorology .......................................... 17
2.1. Stability in the Tropical Atmosphere ................................. 17
2.2. Tropical Cumdonimbi ............................................. 22
2.3. CISK ............................................................ 26
3. Models of a Mature Tropical Cyclone ...................................... 29
3.1. Introduction ..................................................... 29
3.2. The Carrier Model ................................................ 29
3.3. Critique of the Carrier Model ....................................... 33
3.4. Maximum Swirl Speed Estimate According t o the Carrier Model ........ 35
3.5. The Swirl-Divergence Relation for the Frictional Boundary Layer ...... 45
3.6. The Energetics of the Frictional Boundary Layer and Throughput Supply 50
3.7. The Riehl-Malkus Postulate of an Oceanic Heat Source ................ 53
3.8. The Intensity of a Tropical Cyclone and the Underlying Sea Surface
Temperature ..................................................... 55
3.9. Critique of the Riehl-Makus Model ................................. 59
3.10. Numerical Simulation of Hurricanes on Digital Computers ............. 66
.
3.1 1 Implications of Hurricane Models on Seeding ......................... 70
4. Theory of Tropical Cyclone Intensification ................................ 76
4.1. Carrier’s Outline of Intensification ................................... 76
4.2. Critique of the Carrier Model of Intensification ....................... 78
4.3. The Distribution of Cumdonimbi during Intensification ................ 81
4.4. The Time-Dependent Flowfield during Intensification .................. 82
5 . ConcludingRemarks .................................................... 86
Appendix A. Estimating the Kinetic Energy and Water Content of Hurricanes 87
Appendix B . The Moist Adiabat ........................................ 88
Partial List of Symbols ................................................ 92
References ............................................................ 93
Note Addedin Proof .................................................. 100
1
2 FRANCIS E. FENDELL
1. INTRODUCTION
For the East Coast of the United States, the hurricane-generated storm surge
depends on storm direction, but can be roughly estimated from s = 2.90-9.70 x
+
( v ) ~ 1.33 x , < (v),,,,~ < 149, where ( v ) is~the
~ ~X 1 0 - 3 ( 0 ) ~ a74 ~ maximum
~ wind speed
in miles per hour and s is the surge above normal in feet [based on Saffir (1973)]. How-
ever, the crudity of such simple empirical relations becomes evident when one recognizes
that the storm surge (which may precede, wcompany, or lag the center of the hurricane)
is sensitive to the storm translation speed and size, as well as direction relative to the
coast; the shelf dope and bathymetry; the radius and magnitude of the maximum wind
speed, and the general radial profile of the swirl; and the central pressure deficit. In
addition t o onshore wind-driven waves, with the arrival of a hurricane, and persisting
often for about a day after its passing along a coast with a sloping bottom (myY,of
inclination angle p), arise so-called edge waves. These waves travel parallel t o the coast;
their crests are normal to the coast. I f the component of the hurricane translational
velocity parallel to the coast is denoted U , the period of the waves is (27rU/g sin p) and
the wavelength is (27rU2/gsin p); typically for the East Coast of the United States the
period is 5-7 hr, and the wavelength is 400 km. The amplitude vanishes rapidly from the
shore seaward, and is negligible at the distance of one wavelength; the amplitude is
roughly given by the inverse barometer rule (one centimeter water rise per millibar of
atmospheric pressure drop) so heights of two t o three feet are typical (Munk et al., 1956)
Sometimes waves generated because of the rate of along-shore hurricane movement
relative to shelf depth cause more flooding than onshore waves.
TROPICAL CYCLONES 3
Atlantic (Atkinson, 1971). Under the current state of the art for path pre-
dictions for either military or civilian use, three times the area actually hit
by a hurricane is typically placed under hurricane warnings (Meyer, 1971a;
Malone and Leimer, 1971).Anderson and Burnham (1973)note that a swarth
650 n miles wide will typically be placed under hurricane warnings; destruc-
tion usually covers about a 250 n miles wide path, but 200 n miles to each side
must be placed under warnings owing t o the current 122 n miles mean position
error in 24 hr forecasts of hurricane landfall. If one assumes 10 landfalls a
season, then Anderson and Burnham estimate a $15.2 million savings by the
20 yo of U.S. Gulf Coast residents who take protective measures, the first
year after the mean position error of landfall is reduced to 70 n miles. I n
the greater Miami area, current estimates suggest that a t least $2 million
are spent on preparations whenever hurricane warnings are issued
(Simpson, 1971). Unnecessary preparation by the United States Department
of Defense installations owing to false hurricane and typhoon warnings costs
$8.3 million annually, exclusive of diversion-of-manpower costs. Thus, the
mere threat of hurricanes incurs expenditure of prodigious sums.
a t least a thousand miles in diameter and ten miles in height (i.e. they
extend from sea level to tropical tropopause). Not only do most typhoons
form in the autumn, but also the most intense ones occur then (Brand, 1970a).
These vortical storms are cyclonic in the Northern Hemisphere and anti-
cyclonic (North Pole reference) in the Southern Hemisphere, and take many
days to intensify-indicating that the small Coriolis force is the source of
angular momentum and explaining why intensification within fj0 of the geo-
graphic equator is very rare. I n fact, conservation of angular momentum in
itself indicates that a fluid particle in the tropics drawn in about five hundred
miles will swirl a t several hundred miles per hour.
With satellite photography, inspection of broad ocean expanses has im-
proved, and some former estimates about the frequency of tropical cyclones
have had to be revised (Large environmental-data-gathering ocean buoys,
of which two experimental forerunners are currently deployed by the U.S.
Department of Commerce in the Gulf of Mexico, may eventually play a large
role in hurricane detection.) About three-quarters of the annual global total
of fifty tropical cyclones occur in the Northern Hemisphere. I n the North
Atlantic about 60% of the nine tropical storms that typically occur annually
intensify into tropical cyclones; in the eastern North Pacific, 33% of 14;
and in the western North Pacific, 66 % of 30 (Atkinson, 1971).Since there are
daily disturbances in the tropics in autumn, a weak disturbance has a poor
chance ( 10 yo)of becoming a tropical storm, but any disturbance that does
N
10" and 20" of the equator, with only 13 % poleward of this region and only
22 % equatorward (Atkinson, 1971). The absence-of-a-vertical-wind-shear
criterion may explain the anomalous cyclone season for the northern Indian
Ocean (in the Arabian Sea, the Bay of Bengal, and even the South China
Sea);in these areas, rather than a single autumnal peak, twin peaks in cyclone
frequency occur in fall and spring, with a relatively uneventful summer
season (Palm& and Newton, 1969). (The displacement during the summer of
the low-level trough northward over land so westerlies generally cover most,
if not all, of the North Indian Ocean, is probably another contributing factor
for the lull between the greater peak of activity in the fall and the lesser
peak of activity in the spring.) Gray (1968) suggests that unless cumulo-
nimbi retain vertical integrity, the atmospheric lightening associated with
them is dissipated by being advected in different directions at different
altitudes (" ventilated "). Climatologically, regional differences in vertical
wind shear within the tropics become most evident in the upper troposphere.
Gray (1968) also asserts that the up- and down-drafts in cumulonimbi
themselves help suppress enhancement of vertical wind shear as baroclinicity
increases during intensification of tropical depressions. Vertical wind shear
a t upper tropospheric levels prevents the higher structure of some typhoons
from getting fully organized, although the structure may be well defined in
the lower troposphere; such so-called shallow typhoons are invariably of
minimal hurricane intensity (Varga, 1971).
Particular features of the North Atlantic hurricane season are now enu-
merated. 'As the peak of the hurricane season approaches, the region where
tropical storms reach hurricane intensity moves eastward from the Gulf of
Mexico and the Caribbean to the Cape Verde Islands; as the peak hurricane
season passes, the spawning ground moves westward again t o the Caribbean
(Meyer, 1971a). Coincidentally, there is a latitudinal movement northward in
the first half of the season, then a retreat equatorward (Riehl, 1954, p. 323).
Cyclogenesis poleward of 20"N is a particular characteristic of the North
Atlantic; in fact, for the past four years the tropical North Atlantic has been
mostly free of hurricanes, which have been forming a t 25"N and higher
(Simpson and Frank, 1972). I n 1972, for example, there were only eight
hurricane days in the North Atlantic Ocean (second lowest total since 1930),
while there were 33 hurricane days in the eastern North Pacific Ocean, and
121 typhoon days in the western North Pacific (21 more typhoon days than
average, and the highest number since 1959). Lower than normal sea-surface
temperature and greater than normal vertical wind shear (owing t o strong
high-level westerlies) have been advanced as possible explanations for the
recent decrease in hurricane activity in the North Atlantic.
At one time discussion of tropical cyclogenesis inevitably evoked discussion
of waves in the easterlies (Riehl, 1954). But in recent years attention has
TROPICAL CYCLONES 7
focused on (1)the role of the ICTZ and (2) twice-weekly autumnal disturb-
ances that begin as large cyclonic sandstorms of 1000 n miles extent over
Africa and that drift westward a t up to 10 knots. There may well be two
different sources c'hurricane seedlings, and if so, the relative rolesof latent and
sensible heat in each may differ (Garstang, 1972).
1. Tropical cyclones tend to form on the poleward side of the equatorial
trough; in fact, 80-85 % of synoptic scale tropical disturbances form within
2"-4" of the equatorial trough on the poleward side. Disturbances are rarer,
smaller, and weaker when the trough is closest to the equator. The trough is
maintained by the CISK process (Section 2.3),since low-level meridional moist
inflow sustains the persistent cloudiness of this perennial low-pressure region.
Further, there islow-level cyclonicshear frominteraction of easterlies poleward
of the trough and westerlies equatorward of the trough. On a zonally averaged
basis around the globe, the equatorial trough annually migrates from 15"N
to 5’5, lagging the solar zenith by about two months as it does so (Riehl,
1972a). Byers (1944) attributes the absence of hurricanes intheSouthAtlantic
largely to the failure of the ITCZ to become displaced south of the equator,
even in February, a t longitudes extending from the eastern Pacific to western
Africa. Agee (1972) has presented an interesting sequence of satellite photo-
graphs documenting a case of tropical cyclogenesis in the vicinity of the ITCZ
in late July, 1972.
2. If it is possible t o correlate tropical North Atlantic disturbanceswiththe
ITCZ, it is also possible t o correlate them with disturbances first formed over
the mountainous east African bulge, that migrate westward (Carlson, 1969).
Half the disturbances over the tropical North Atlantic can be so traced;
further, half of these disturbances can then be traced across Central America
to the eastern Pacific. Actually 75 yoof eastern Pacific storms originate east
of Central America. A significant percentage of midseason hurricanes (August
and September) have African origins; analyses of dust samples taken on
Caribbean isles after hurricane passage reportedly confirm the African origin
of the storm systems (Jennings, 1970). The sometimes turbid disturbances
migrating westward from the arid Sahara may not adjust to the maritime
environment until they are over mid Atlantic. An interesting case documented
by Denny (1972) is an African seedling identified on September 7, 1971, which
became a depression on September 11 and Atlantic Hurricane Irene on
September 18. The system crossed southern Nicaragua on September 20 and
regenerated t o eastern Pacific Hurricane Olivia (948 mb central pressure)
before dying on September 28 near Baja, California.
There are many other correlations of tropical cyclone formation that may
be attempted; for example Carpenter et al. (1972) have recently suggested
a major peak in hurricane formation near a new moon, a minor peak a t full
moon, and minima a t last quarter and several days after f i s t quarter.
8 FRANUIS E. FENDELL
However, the correlations with the ITCZ and African seedlings just discussed
have the advantage of inherent plausible physical mechanisms. Discussion of
modeling of tropical cyclogenesis will be taken up in Section 4.
FIG. 2. NASA photograph of Hurricane Gladys west of Naples, Florida taken from
Apollo 7 on October 7, 1968. The maximum wind speed was 65 knots at this time, and
the tropopause was at 54,000 ft.
the near moist adiabat vertical sequence of states that characterize an ap-
preciable portion of the eyewall; and that a cyclostrophic balance (balance of
radial pressure gradient and centrifugal force), together with an algebraic
decay of the swirl with increasing radial distance from the axis, yields on the
average a fairly good estimate of the maximum swirl speed.
Outside the eyewall, the precipitation rate falls off roughly linearly with
distance from the center of the tropical cyclone. Cloud cells in the eyewall
are typically 5 to 20 km thick and a few of the smaller ones can rain over
15 cm/hr. Spiral bands out to 150 km yield 1 cm/hr, and further out 0.25 cm/hr
-though individual convective cells of 1 km horizontal scale can give much
heavier rainfall. I n the low rainfall area the precipitation is probably snow
10 FRANCIS E. FENDELL
that turns t o rain a t the melting level (Meyer, 1971a,b). Incidentally, clouds
in a hurricane are probably strained by the rapid swirl into the spiral band
pattern seen on radar screens or in satellite photographs The spiral bands
give visualization t o parts of the strain pattern, rather than streamline
pattern. A rainband persists typically for one to two hours (Gentry, 1964).
I n addition to rainfall, storm surge, large waves, and high winds, tropical
cyclones can spawn tornadoes and waterspouts of moderate intensity (Orton,
1970). These are usually reported for the region outside the domain of hurri-
cane winds, but this may only mean that twisters are more easily discernible
from the general vortical intensity in the outer portions. One would expect
tornadoes t o be most closely associated with the intense convection and large
swirl of the inner rainbands. However, the fact remains that tornadoes have
been observed mainly in the outer portions (i.e., where the surface pressure
exceeds 1000 mb), soon after landfall of a formerly intense, rapidly decaying
hurricane. Perhaps the intrusion (sometimes associated with the occurrence
of tornadoes) into the storm of midtropospheric ambient dry air is significant.
Most tornadoes are reported for the right forward quadrant, with respect to
an observer looking along the direction of translation. This seems plausible
because for North Atlantic hurricanes that quadrant is also the most severe
TROPICAL CYCLONES 11
have serious consequences, the subject is pursued here briefly. For 1971,
short term (12-36 hr) path forecasts by the National Hurricane Center were
best made by the use of past climatological and analogue data. (What did
previous hurricanes in a similar situation do?) Methods based on historical
data are referred t o as “objective.” For 1971, for long term (48-72 hr), NHC
found methods based on dynamical principles superior (R. Simpson, private
communication). Today the average error for 24-hr predictions of hurricane
movement is 129 n miles; the average landfall error for a 24-hr prediction is
about 100 n miles. The reduction is due to the closer monitoring of tropical
storms as they approach the Atlantic and Gulf coasts (Simpson, 1971). The
less accurate forecasts often entail faster moving storms, and storms a t
latitudes poleward of the trades, where recurvature may occur.
Many dynamical techniques treat the tropical cyclone as a point vortex
steered in a current, which has been smoothed t o remove the influence of the
circulation of the storm itself. The steering current may be the flowat a specific
level, usually in the mid- or upper troposphere [Byers (1944, p. 447) cited
10,000 ft]. More recent work emphasizes the use of a steering layer; Riehl
(1954, p. 345) advocated the use of a pressure weighted mean flow from the
surface to 300 mb, over a band 8” latitude in width centered on the storm, to
predict hurricane direction and speed. Today prognostic flow is sometimes
used t o predict path. Further, the barotropic model of Sanders and Burpee
(1968) averages over the depth of the troposphere fron 100 to 1000 mb, and
does not involve reduction of the tropical cyclone to a point vortex. Despite
such improvements, the outlook for reducing path forecast errors by more
sophisticated dynamical prediction models is not favorable:
Numerical models for predicting the movement and development of hurricanes
remain a frail source of guidance to the hurricane forecaster for three reasons.
First, an error in direction of movement as small as 8 t o 10 degrees-nominally
a n acceptable one in a 24-hour forecast for extratropical storm centers-can yield
disastrous results in hurricane warnings if followed literally. Second, the perform-
ance of most hurricane prediction models depends significantly upon the initial
direction of movement of the center, which in turn depends upn an exact know-
ledge of the current center position and the position 6 and 12 hours earlier. The
average positioning error is more than 20 nm, and often leads to initial direction
errors of 15-20 degrees. Finally the forecaster remains hard put t o identify and
diagnose the frailties of numerical prediction models for individual forecasts. All
too often this has led to near abandonment of the guidance materials and the
application of empirical and individual experience factors in decision making.
(Simpson, 1971, p. 1.)
FIG.4. Schematic features of the atmosphere i n winter. Latent heat evaported from
tropical oceans to the lower-level trades is carried toward the ITCZ by the sketched
meridional flow; the air rises as the ITCZ is approached, and the latent heat ultimately is
released as sensible heat and gravitational potential energy. Height of the local tropo-
pause is marked. Portions of the general circulation are less well d e h e d in summer. TA
denotes tropical air; MLA, niidlatitude air; PA, polar air; STJ, subtropical jet stream;
and PFJ, polar front jet stream. (By permission from PalmBn and Newton (1969,
p. 669), Academic Press, New York).
play in maintaining the currents of larger scale. He also noted that hurricanes
often do not appear in numerical simulations of the general circulation on
advanced digital computers. Of course, appearance is hardly to be expected
when restraints on computing time severely limit resolution; for example, the
Mintz-Arakawa model is currently treated for a 5-deg longitudinal and a
4-deg latitudinal spatial grid with a 6-min time step, such that about 20 min
of computer time is needed to simulate a day of climate (Rapp, 1970; Gates
et al., 1971). The resolution for disturbances of dimension less than lo00 n
miles is poor, but two weeks of computer time per day of simulated climate
would be required on most computers if satisfactory resolution on a 100 n
mile scale were sought. Meteorologists a t the Rand Corporation in Santrt
Monica, California planned to program the two-level Mintz-Arakawa model
of the general atmospheric circulation for the advanced ILLIAC IV com-
puter. Even if such plans are realized, a grid no finer than 1" x 1" seems
practical; thus, if and when hurricanes are added t o the global circulation
model, their role may have to be introduced by parameterization guided by
more fundamental studies (such as a subroutine with finer grid activated on
appropriate occasions). After all, cumulus convection, radiational cooling,
TROPICAL CYCLONES 15
1909) (Alaka, 1968). The daily production of condensed water for precipita-
tion in a mature hurricane has been estimated at 1.6 x l0ls gm (Ooyama,
1969, p. 29). A weather system with such energy and water content, that
extends radially hundreds of miles and vertically from sea level to the
tropical tropopause, and that persists for weeks, would seem no local accident.
Third, hurricanes occur annually, mainly in the autumn after the long heating
of the tropical oceans by solar radiation, and hurricanes do turn poleward
after drifting westward in the trades. These facts invite the previously stated
speculation that hurricanes &reseasonally part of a substitute mechanism for
relaxing energy poleward when the Hadley cell mechanism is not sdlicient.
If so, then the paradox discussed by Bates (1972, pp. 2, 14) is perhaps res-
olved:‘‘ TheHadley cell of the summer hemisphere is weak or non-existent. ...
There seems to be a paradox in the fact that while the Hrcdley cell is most
intense in winter, the frequency of oceanic tropical disturbances, which one
would expect to be an important contributor to its rising branch, is greatest
in summer.’’ Even if temporally and longitudinally varying eddy transfer
associated with pressure troughs, rather than the zonally symmetric mean
meridional (Hadley) cell, is the primary mechanism by which moisture and
angular momentum are transported from the tropics to the midlatitudes
(Riehl, 1954, Chapter 12; Riehl, 1969a), still, a significant portion of the eddy
transfer occurs in the upper troposphere. The mode by which quantities to be
transferred are convected to appreciable height in the tropics is cumulonimbus
clouds, and, as discussed later, these occur in abundance in hurricanes. The
basic suggestion remains: hurricanes may play some role in the fall in the
export of energy from the tropics to the midlatitudes by what they export
themselves, and by what they convect to the upper tropospheric levels in the
tropics for other mechanisms to export.
However, on an annual and global basis, vertical transfer in the tropics is
carried out by smaller scale, but more numerous convective systems (PalmBn
and Newton, 1969, p. 572). In fact, it is now suggested that only about one
percent of the total energy annually exported from the tropics to the mid-
latitudes is conveyed by hurricanes. For convenience, suppose in a year there
are 100 hurricanes, each lasting 18.25 days and covering lo6 miles2. The
surface area of the tropics (with 30” serving as the limit) is about lo8miles2.
The fraction of the total annual total static enthalpy H transferred by
hurricanes is
R = ( 100)( 18.25)lo6(aH/az)o , h/( 365)10*( aH/az)o, ~
be larger if the model of Malkus and Riehl (1960) were used. These authors
assert that a t the sea surface in a moderate intensity hurricane (966 mb central
pressure) the Bowen ratio (ratio of sensible t o latent heat transfer) is about
0.2, and that the latent heat transfer is augmented by a factor of 10-12 over
the ambient level in the trades.
2. ASPECTSOF TROPICAL
METEOROLOGY
Here cPis the heat capacity of the atmosphere (effectively that of dry air, and
independent of temperature for present purposes) ; T is the static temperature;
g the magnitude of the gravitational acceleration; z the height above sea level;
L the relevant latent heat of phase transition for water substance; and Y
the mass fraction of water vapor. Throughout this paper, whenever H is
(loosely) described as a temperature, reference is to (Hlc,). Actually the total
enthalpy of a fluid particle is the total stagnation enthalpy
200
TROPICAL CYCLONES 19
FIG.6. The average total static temperature (Hlc,) for the Northern Hemisphere in
winter. The curve marked A denotes the locus of the minimum of ( H / c p ) free
; convection
can most readily occur below level A, and only undilute ascent can continue much above
A; undilute ascent continues t o level B, where sea level values are recovered. (By per-
mission from Palmen and Newton, 1969, p. 574. Academic Press, New York.)
for the onset of condensation, in which case it will rise until its density dis-
crepancy relative t o ambient is reduced to zero (i.e. rise to a new equilibrium
position). Statically unstable means unstable without the requirement of a
suEciently large displacement. If the atmosphere is dry, or if for some reason
one wants to consider stability excluding the role played by condensation
(dry ascent as opposed t o moist ascent), then the atmosphere is stable if
(aO/az) > 0, and unstable if (ae/az) <0.
I n the extratropics, H and 8 both increase monotonically with altitude
usually, so the atmosphere is stable to both dry and moist ascent (Fig. 6).
Only in exceptional circumstances, as in thunderstorms, does penetrative
convection, with its vertical (as opposed t o slantwise) ascent, occur. I n the
tropics 8 increases monotonically with height, but H (as previously noted) has
a midtropospheric minimum (Fig. 7);thus air is stable to dry ascent, but air
in. the lower atmosphere is unstable to moist ascent (convectively unstable).
How turbulent mixing, cumulus convection, radiational cooling, cumu-
lonimbi (see below), and large-scale circulation maintain this condition of
convective instability deals with tropical meteorology in general, and lies
largely outside the scope of this review of tropical cyclones (although such
distinction will probably soon prove unsound with incipient progress in
tropical cyclogenesis). Actually a full understanding of how the tropical
ambient is maintained does not exist; the complexity is indicated by the fact
that, as will now be explained, the H profile generates different types of
clouds, which in turn sustain the H profile.
I n the convectively unstable tropical atmosphere, the larger the lapse rate,
the more suppressed is the cumulus activity. Only as the ambient lapse rate
- 50
-40
-30
--
N
0
X
4
90
-20
- 10
1 (OK)
FIG. 7. Static temperature T, potential temperature-like measure (6/cp), total static temperature (H/cp),and the total static
temperature for a hypothetical atmosphere saturated at the actual local temperature and pressure (I?/cp)vs. height and pressure for
the West Indies ambient for September. Based on data given by Jordan (1957). A parcel at height z1 will become buoyant a t z o
where (Hlc,) at z1 exceeds ( a / c , ) at zo( > z , ) ; the inequality is satisfied for air in the planetary boundary layer, and little else.
22 FRANCIS E. FENDELL
tropics normally, but -(aTlaz) 6.0°C/km in the inner rain area of Hurricane
N
Daisy (1958). There have been many confirmations since, that the less pro-
nounced the midtropospheric minimum of the total static enthalpy in the
tropics, the more convective activity is likely t o be present (Garstang et al.,
1970; Aspliden, 1971).
If a glob of very low-level tropical air (buoyant element) is displaced
vertically enough for condensation to occur, ascent will continue many
kilometers virtually to the tropical tropopause, under the stability criteria
just presented, if the ascent is rapid enough for no mixing or radiational
cooling t o occur during ascent. Near sea level air would rise dry adiabatically
until saturated (roughly, 50 mb) ; thereafter, enough precipitation would fall
out to leave the air just saturated a t the local pressure and temperature, the
air retaining the latent heat of phase transition. Such a locus of thermodyn-
amic states is conventionally referred t o as the moist adiabat; for rapid
ascent in which ambient processes are too slow to act, H s ~ o n s t(Air
. ~ that
has risen to its level of neutral buoyancy will not be unstable t o descent,
because any compressional heat from work done on the fluid by gravitational
forces cannot be absorbed by the condensed water substance, which has
precipitated out. However, descending flow will accompany ascent, and this
will be addressed in Section 2.3.)
The core of a towering cumulonimbus is described by a moist adiabat.
The tropical ambient must be close to moist adiabatic for cumulonimbi t o
be significant; this is in fact the case (Riehl, 1969a, b). If the ambient were
moist adiabatic, cumulonimbi would be unnecessary because the ambient
would be too unstable (there would be gross convective lifting). If the
ambient were far removed from moist adiabatic, cumulonimbi would be
nonexistent because the atmosphere would be too stable (there would be no
lifting, just heating up of the air).
cb
FIG.S. The total static temperature (Hlc,) over the ocean in the equatorial trough and
in the tropics near the subtropics, as a function of pressure. Both typical cumulus loci
(cu) and also cumulonimbus loci (cb) are noted. (Based on, with permission, Palmen
and Newton, 1969, p. 575. Academic Press, New York.)
FIQ.9. NASA photograph taken in June, 1966 from Gemini IV of cumulus, cumulo-
nimbus, and cirrus clouds over the Pacific Ocean off the western coast of Central America;
the view is northeast toward Mexico.
gm/cma-day), and 40 yovariable cloud area and 40 yoclear area (this 80 yoof
the area yields negligible precipitation). There tends to be moist ascent in
the cloudy areas, and dry descent in the less cloudy areas, though by evapor-
ation of liquid water and by diffusion of water vapor, water substance is
transferred from the cloudy to less cloudy regions. If the tropics do consist of
cloud clusters of 500 km scale separated by clear (or a t least mostly cloud
free) areas of 200-10,000 km scale, then one anticipates that there is a greater
incidence of cumulonimbi relative t o cumuli in those clusters near the ITCZ
as opposed to those clusters in the trades (see below). Hence, there would be
appreciable upper (lower)tropospheric detrainment from those clusters in the
ITCZ (trades). If the clusters propagate westward a t intervals of several days,
then the cIusters would be associated with thin wave troughs (i.e., low pressure
regions) and the clear areas, with ridges.
These cloud syst,:ms are described here because in some still incompletely
understood manner, they play a role in tropical cyclogeneisis (Palm& and
Newton, 1969, p. 585).Although tropical cyclogenesis is marked by the exist-
TROPICAL CYCLONES 25
ence of relatively little variation of the zonal wind with height, cloud
clusters in which the easterly wind speed aloft exceeds that near the surface
tend t o spawn storms. Cumulonimbi are given particular attention because
although they cover one one-thousandth (PalmBn and Newton, 1969, p. 440)
to possibly four-thousandths (Gray, 1972b, p. 33) of the area of a n equatorial
belt extending 10"latitude on each side of the equatorial trough, they cover
one-tenth of the area of the trough itself (Bates, 1972, p. 2). Tropical cyclo-
genesis often occurs near the equatorial trough, and cumulonimbi occur in
concentration in the hurricane eyewall (Section 4.3). I n fact, the absence of
cumulonimbi in subtropical cyclones occurring off western India, over the
Pacific, and over the Atlantic serves as one means of distinguishing these
storms (in which maximum intensity is reached in midtroposphere, and in
which a warm core occurs at high levels but a cold core a t low levels) from
tropical cyclones (Walker, 1972). [Simpson and Pelisser (1971)discuss various
so-called hybrid storms in and near the tropics, that may have hurricane force
winds a t least transiently, but do not have conventional hurricane s t r ~ c t u r e . 1 ~
A cumulonimbus (cb) is typified by a radius of 2 km, a lifespan of 30 to
40 min, a height of 14 km, a peak water substance content of 4 gm/cm3,
maximum updraft speed of 25 m/sec, a thermal anomaly of 6"C, and a total
rainfall of 2.4 cm. I n contrast, a cumulus (cu) is typified by a radius of 1 km
or less, a lifetime of 10 t o 25 min, a height of 6 km, a peak water content of
1 gm/cm3, maximum updraft speed of 6 m/sec, a thermal anomaly of 4"C,
and a total rainfall of 0.3 cm (Lopez, 1972a). Cumulonimbi are observed to
overshoot their neutral stability level and then oscillate about it; further,
only the core of a cloud rises undilute because only the larger clouds reach
upper tropospheric levels (Malkus, 1960). Riehl and Malkus (1961) estimate
that a cumulonimbus conveys about 6 x lo1O gm/sec and that a fluid particle
rises the full vertical extent in about 30 min.
In the summer tropics there is far more local ascent and descent than might
be suggested by the mean synoptic scale motion (Johnson, 1969; Gray,
1972b); in fact, if air in the equatorial trough rose only with the mean vertical
flow, the ascent would be so slow that radiational cooling alone would stop it
in midtroposphere (PalmBn and Newton, 1969) and cumulonimbi would not
exist. Gray (1972b) suggests that there is ten to twenty times the mean s p -
optic convergence in the lower summertime tropical atmosphere, and this is
the source of the initial forced vertical displacement thatleadsto condensation
and permits free convection to continue undiluted ascent in the unsaturated
conditionally unstable ambient conditions. Without one or two orders of
magnitude more up and down recirculatory local motion than suggested by
Further discussion of hybrid (or semitropical) storms, which rely for energy source
not only on latent heat release but also on baroclinicity associated with positioning of
warm and cold air masses, is given by Spiegler (1972).
26 FRANCIS E. FENDELL
the mean synoptic scale motion, the water substance distribution in the sum-
mertime tropics (in which individual cumulonimbi can rain a t 2.5 cm/day
even though the evaporation rate at the sea surface is a uniform 0.5 cm/day)
is inexplicable. This large local recirculation may have implications for the
momentum balance because it would seem to inhibit vertical wind shear
development.
Malkus and Riehl (1960) described the tropical cumulonimbus as a hot
tower because sensible heat from condensation was supposedly available t o
warm the ambient surrounding air. Lopez (1972b), however, asserts that
cooling tower would be more apropos because the condensational heat is
primarily used t o raise the air in the column t o its level of neutral stability
(i.e., the heat goes into potential energy). The air that is detrained from the
cloud serves to cool the environment because the heat extracted from the
ambient t o reevaporated condensed moisture in the detrained air exceeds any
sensible heat transferred to the surrounding environment. Measurement23
around cumuIus activity indicate that the static temperature often falls (e.g.,
Riehl, 1969b, p. 588). Of course, the ascent in a cloud cluster does indirectly
engender drying and warming through the subsidence of surrounding air
that inevitably accompanies ascent in the cloud; this heating counteracts
heat loss to detrainment and radiation. Thus on a large scale cumulonimbus
activity generates a net warming, but the effect on the locally surrounding air
is cooling (Gray, 1972b). Most models parameterizing the role of cumulus
convection in large-scale disturbances have the direct sensible heat transfer
model, rather than the indirect warming-by-subsidence mechanism, in mind
(see Section 3.10). The Riehl-Malkus hot-tower model is inconsistent with the
existence of large local recirculatory motion (Gray, 1972b).
2.3. CISK
Among the most important and fruitful concepts introduced in tropical
meteorology in several decades is an idea due to Charney (Charney and
Eliassen, 1964; Charney, 1971); the concept of CISK (conditional instability
of the second kind), in addition to whatever contribution it may make to
extratropical meteorology, seems of great utility in describing tropical phe-
nomena of widely different scales, ranging from asingle cumulonimbus to
hurricane rainbands t o cloud clusters to tropical cyclones to the ITCZ (the
intertropical convergence zone is, for present purposes, taken as identical
with the equatorial trough, the doldrums, and the trade confiuence). I n all
these phenomena there is low-level convergence with large moisture content
in the presence of appreciable Coriolis force. Phillips (1970) notes that while
the physical procssses involved in CISK can be qualitatively described, much
remains to be done with respect t o detailed quantitative description (Geissler,
1972).
TROPICAL CYCLONES 27
3. MODELSOF A MATURETROPICAL
CYCLONE
3.1. Introduction
I n sorting out the thermohydrodynamics of a tropical cyclone, one is
faced with understanding the interaction of two scales of phenomena: the
larger cyclone scale (-500 to 1000 miles), and the smaller cumulus scale
( 1 mile). The cyclone must feed the cumulus scale, which in turn sustains
N
top of the storm is taken to be that height (-150 mb) a t which sea level air
in the outer part of the storm, if lifted rapidly so that the total enthalpy of a
fluid particle remained constant because relatively slow ambient-maintaining
processes would not have time t o act, would no longer be unstable relative
t o the local ambient air. Such rapid lifting is, of course, the moist adiabatic
ascent discussed in Section 2.1. This “ instability lid ” lies a t so great a height
that there is virtually negligible swirl, as explained below; the ambient
pressure and temperature a t this height are taken to describe all radial
positions a t this height, from the center to the outer edge. Thus, the top of the
storm is an isothermal, isobaric, constant altitude lid with no water vapor
content for current purposes.
Discussion now turns to describing each of the four regions comprising the
tropical cyclone in some detail.
I n region I there is warm moist air typical in stratification of the ambient
atmosphere in which the hurricane was generated. This air spun up under
conservation of angular momentum as it moved in toward the axis of sym-
metry during the formative stage. As the mature stage was approached,
a gradient wind balance of pressure, Coriolis and centrifugal forces choked
off any further inflow; the inflow is only enough to prevent the eyewall
I11 from diffusing outward, and that requires only an exceedingly small
radial flow. The air in I, then, is rapidly swirling, the azimuthal velocity
component greatly increasing and the pressure greatly decreasing from the
edge to the center. Under such a radial profile for the swirl, there is a small
downflux from the throughput supply I into the frictional boundary layer IS.
The small downflux leads to a large net mass flux into the frictional layer
because of the large area involved. Furthermore, the downdraft is only a gross
temporal and azimuthal average because locally and transiently there is
intense convective activity by which clouds form and rain falls.
I n the frictional boundary layer 11, the only region in which angular
momentum is not conserved but is partially lost to thesea, thereisappreciable
influx. I n fact, the azimuthal and radial velocity components are of compar-
able magnitude; typically, for fixed radial position, the maximum inflow speed
a t any axial position in the boundary layer is about one-third the maximum
azimuthal speed. [This fraction is close t o the one reported by Hughes
(1952) from flight penetration of hurricanes a t altitudes of 1000 f t or less.]
The vertical velocity component is much smaller. The reason for the inflow is,
as previously discussed, that the no-slip boundary condition reduces the
centrifugal acceleration, and a relatively uncompensated pressure gradient
drives the fluid toward the axis of symmetry (so-called “tea cup effect ”).
Far from the axis in I1 the classical balance of the linear Ekman layer (friction,
pressure, and Coriolis forces) suffices; since the downdraft from I to I1 is
probably fairly independent of radial position (especially far from the
TROPICAL CYCLONES 31
under 90 knots). Incidentally, if the size is determined by the average diameter of the
closed surface isobar, the size of a storm decreases by 1 7 % in area in crossing the
Philippines, and near the Philippines the intense typhoon has a mean outer circulation
diameter 60-150 n miles greater than that of a weaker typhoon (Brand and Blellock,
1972).
TROPICAL CYCLONES 33
t t
ALTITUDE,
I I -
t-l MI)-
*
FIG.10. This conjectured configuration of a mature hurricane with rough order of
magnitude dimensions is not drawn to scale. The subdomains are: I, throughput supply, a
region of rapid swirl and very slow downdrift; 11, frictional boundary layer; 111, eyewall;
and IV, eye. Across the boundary layer there is about a 100 mb drop, and across I, a
further drop of about 200 mb; the pressure a t the top of the hurricane is about 150 mb,
i.e. the top is near the tropopause. The eye-eyewall interface is taken to slope outward,
though the effect may not be so pronounced as sketched.
after landfall, according to the Carrier model, was discussed earlier. The fact
that friction effects the low-level moisture convergence suggests small
increases in friction may even cause intensification.] However, the most
novel contribution of the Carrier model is identification of the “fuel supply”
in I, which requires only ambient level sea-to-air total stagnation enthalpy
transfer for maintenance. That the fluid in I does sink down into I1 is suggested
by the observation by Gentry (1964, p. 64) that a t lower altitudes the tem-
peratures are lower in the outer rainbands than in the surrounding air. There
is little undiluted ascent from the inflow to the outflow layer. Rather, even the
air which ascends in the outer rainbands also descends again in the storm
area, and is not immediately carried away through the outflow layer in the
upper troposphere.
The grossest feature of the Carrier model is the absence of any refinement
t o the eyewall structure. While for decades modelers have presented mean
soundings in the eyewall that suggest moist adiabatic ascent from the surface
layers (Palm& and Newton, 1969, pp. 477482), Shea (1972) emphasizes that
the ascent is limited to cumulonimbi that cover only 10 to 20 yoof theeyewall
area. Subsidence occurs in the regions of the eyewall outside cumulonimbi.
Using flight data that include intensifying and decaying as well as mature
tropical cyclones, Shea asserts that the relative humidityprobablyisnot 100 %
throughout the eyewall, and there is a small midtropospheric minimum in
TROPICAL CYCLONES 35
mean vertical profiles of the equivalent potential temperature (far less pro-
nounced than the ambient minimum). I n fact, wet-bulb effects may have led
to spuriously low temperature measurements a t midtropospheric heights
(Gentry, 1964). I n any case, the failure to delineate this structure does not
have significant repercussions for Carrier’s work on the mature hurricane, but
does have important implications on his work on intensification, to be dis-
cussed later (Section 4).Shea also suggests that the gradient wind balance
does not hold to good approximation in the eyewall; if so, this is probably
due to a contribution from the transient partial derivative of the radial
velocity component, and is not taken t o modify analyses of a mature hurricane
appreciably.
I n the following sections three specific analyses among the many carried
out by Carrier and his co-workers t o help substantiate the model will be
briefly reviewed. The three analyses involve maximum swirl speed estimation,
the dynamics of a nonlinear Ekman layer, and the energetics of the surface
frictional layer. The quantitative results achieved t o date concerning the
Carrier model have been attained without large-scale digital computation.
The emphasis on subdivisional investigation of the four regions of the storm,
with interfacial compatibility, permits a substantially analytic approach.
It should be noted that although certain linearizations are sometimes adopted
for tractability by Carrier and his co-workers in the course of their analysis,
Carrier’s model for the mature hurricane is definitely nonlinear, and solutions
derived by such linearizations are acceptable only if, a posteriori, they can be
demonstrated t o satisfy the original nonlinear boundary value problem with
acceptably small error. Without prior proof of internal self-consistency by
subdivisional analyses, a full numerical treatment of the basic boundary value
problem would seem premature.
requiring any enthalpy transfer from the ocean greatly i n excus of the ambient
transfer, provided the eyewall i s not perfectly vertical. Miller (1958) performed
somewhat similar calculations to those to be described and also noted
that the Riehl-Malkus postulate of large oceanic latent and sensible heat
transfer to air flowing in through the frictional layer was not required to
explain low central pressure.
The f k t step is to neglect the frictional boundary layer 11, which is rel-
atively thin and across which, except for hydrostatic variations, the pressure
does not change according to lowest order boundary layer theory.
The variation of pressure p , density p, and the temperature T with height
above the ocean z, for any ambient tropical atmosphere in which a hurricane
forms, may be computed from
(6) Pa = Pa R a T (a = dry air)
(7) p v = pv RET / u (v = water vapor; u = 0.622)
(8) P =Pa +Pv 9 p =P a +P v , P" = P(T)(RH)
(9) dpldz = -pg
(10) T=f(P),RH=g(P)
where the temperature profile f ( p ) and the relative humidity (RH) profile
g ( p ) are taken as known from measurement. The saturation pressure P ( T )is
well tabulated for vapor and liquid phases above freezing, and vapor and solid
below freezing (Keenan and Keyes, 1936); a convenient and accurate expres-
sion for P(T) in millibars was given by Tetens (Murray, 1967):
where T is in OK. The integration proceeds from the sea level upward in alti-
tude z; data typically extend from about 1000 mb to 150 mb (Fig. 11).
The top of the storm is normally taken as the height at which the ambient
total stagnation enthalpy (for which the kinetic energy contribution is negli-
gible) recovers its sea level value, as noted earlier; here, however, a slightly
different procedure explained below will be used. The sea level ambient state
is henceforth denoted by subscript s.
In a fully developed storm the air rising up the eyewall ascends in cumulo-
nimbus clouds, and thus follows moist adiabats. The initial states to be used
for the moist adiabats are not necessarily known a priori. If one believes
the total stagnation enthalpy is constant along a streamtube in the surface
frictional layer from the ambient to the eyewall, then the sea level tropical
TROPICAL CYCLONES 37
, ;J
t , I
I
I I
38 FRANCIS E. FENDEIL
ambient state may characterize the total stagnation enthalpy of the stream-
tube rising in the eyewall closest to the storm center (procedure A). [Actually,
mixing inevitably occurs so perhaps a lower total stagnation enthalpy
characteristic of some height above sea level should be used, but the small
distinction is not worth the effort (Carrier, 1971b, p. 158).]While such a choice
for the initial state of an eyewall moist adiabat is sometimes made, and while
such results will be presented here, another preferable procedure B will also be
developed. I n this alternative procedure, the temperature and relative
humidity of the sea level state of the moist adiabat will be taken as known,
but the initial pressure will be taken as unknown (to be determined by itera-
tion for self-consistency to be explained below).
There is also a comment worth noting concerning the equationthatdescribes
the moist adiabat. If one simply takes dH, = 0 with L held constant (Charney,
1971, pp. 357-358), where again H , is the total stagnation enthalpy, then after
manipulation with (6)-(9):
seems to be the case for some tornadoes and waterspouts-then the just
calculated p ( z = 0 ) =p e , p(z = 0 ) = pe would characterize conditions a t
the center of the vortex.
The lid on the storm as calculated here will be higher in procedure B than
in procedure A, for a given ambient. The taller the storm, themoreintenseitis
according to calculations developed here. The same relation holds observation-
ally (Riehl, 1972a, p. 248).
I n a mature hurricane a pressure deficit in excess of ( p s - p e ) is achieved
by having rained-out air entrained from the eyewall sink in a relatively dry
eye under adiabatic recompression. Thus in a hurricane ( p s - p e ) is a lower
bound on the central pressure deficit. For a n upper bound on the deficit
that may be achieved, one may adopt the idealized model that the eye is
completely dry (so no compressional heat is lost to reevaporation) and that the
air entrained into the eye is drawn from the top of the eyewall (or, inany case,
has T = TI, p = p l , Y = 0 at z = zl). The relevant equations are (6)-(9),
RH = 0, and T P ( Y - ~ ) / Y ; integration in the direction of decreasing z yields
N
then
Clearly, (15) holds for the mature hurricane; the maximum swirl is larger in
+
(15) than in (17) by the factor ( n 1)1/2because none of the pressure deficit
from ambient needs t o be expended to maintain rotation of the central
column. Next, although power law decays of swirl with radial distance are
frequently adopted and suffice for current purposes, i t will become evident
40 FRANCIS E. FENDELL
that other forms are at least as plausible, and more convenient, for r 2 R.
I n any case, Miller (1967) suggested from limited data that 0.5 < n <0.65
usually suEces, and Riehl (19634 had chosen n = 0.5; earlier, Byers (1944,
p. 436) had also recommended n A 0.5 and Hughes (1952) considered n 5
0.6-0.7 suitable for an average hurricane. The upshot is that estimates will
be made on the limits n = 0.5 and n = 1.0, although n A 0.5 seems the more
realistic. Finally, the gradient wind equation would probably be more ap-
propriate than the cyclostrophic equation, but the more complicated formula
would give maximum speeds reduced by only five percent from those obtained
from the simple forms (15) and (17).
First, results using procedure A (i.e. taking the total static enthalpy H
constant throughout the radial inflow as well as eyewall region) will be given.
If H is held constant a t sea level ambient conditions b, = 1014 mb, Ts=
299.4"K,(RH), = 0.841, then use of (12) for the moist adiabat gives conden-
sation a t 972 mb (Te 295"K, z A 180 ft). One finds z1= 48,150 ft, p , =
138 mb, T,= 203°K. The eyewall pressure a t sea level p , = 978 mb [with
T,i296"K, (RH)eI 0.9751.The eye pressure a t sea level p , = 894 mb (with
T, = 346°K);this upper bound reflects, it is reiterated, the idealization of a
completely moisture-free eye. As a variant, if sea level ambient conditions were
revised slightly for computing the moist adiabat only [ps= 1014 mb, T,=
299.4"K, (RH), = l.O)], then use of (12) gives z1 = 52,500 ft, p , = 110 mb,
T,= 196.6"K. also,^, 5 945 mb, T,= 297°K;p , = 850 mb, T,= 352.7"K.
As an illustration of the change attendant upon using (13) in place of (12),
one finds for H referenced to the unsaturated sea level ambient [ p s= 1014
mb, TS=299.4"K, (RH),=0.84], saturation again occurs at 972 mb, z e
450 ft; however, x1 = 46,500 ft, p 1 = 150 mb, T, = 205.4"K; further, p , =
988 mb, T,= 297.2"K,(RH), = 0.94 (Figs. 12and 13).Ifthesealevelambient
state is taken as saturated for computing the moist adiabat only, z1 = 50,530
ft, p1 = 122 mb, T1 = 199.6"K;whence, p , = 958 mb, Te = 2973°K.
These results, t o reiterate, have followed procedure A [moist adiabat
based on sea level ambient, as given by Jordan (1957) or modified t o be satu-
rated a t the same temperature and pressure]. The results have been presented
here because such calculations have been performed in the past, and because
the sue of the variances resulting from the use of (13) in place of (12) seemed
worth investigating.
For the superior procedure B (iteration to determine the consistent pressure
a t the base of the eyewall moist adiabat), only (13) will be used. If one adopts
T,= 299.4"K, (RH), = 0.84, one finds convergence for p e = 958 mb (Figs.
14 and 15); incidentally, z, = 50,100 ft, p , e 125 mb, T,s 200°K; further,
saturation occurs a t 918 mb, z A 1300 ft. If L is given the value of the heat of
condensation only, (H/cJs = 343.4"K (sea level ambient), and (H/cP),5
346.4"K (sea level under the moist adiabat). [Under (13), (Hlc,) is not pre-
TROPICAL CYCLONES 41
400-
3
-5
Q.
600-
m-
I
200 220 240 260 280 300 320 340 360
T CK)
FIG.12. The ambient pressure-temperature curve is based on data for the Caribbean
in September given by Jordan (1957). The moist adiabat is based on having sea level
ambient air undergo dry adiabatic expansion until saturation, then moist adiabatic
ascent; the resulting sea level pressure deficit from ambient gives a lower bound on the
central pressure deficit under the adopted model. An upper bound on the deficit is fur-
nished by having the air that rose on the so-called moist adiabat, recompressed dry adia-
batically back down to sea level. Altitudes ar0 associated with the thermodynamic
states by use of hydrostatics and the equations of state for dry air and water vapor.
-Ambient, --- moist adiabat, dry adiabat.
cisely constant on a moist adiabat.] Also, p c = 875 mb, T,= 349°K. Thus it
would seem that the sea level total static temperature needs only to increase
about 3"K, with relative humidity and sea surface temperature held fixed,
for a n appreciably reduced pressure under eyewall cumulonimbi cores.
According to (15), for the deficit ( p s - p e ) = 56 mb, = 155 mph for
n = 0.5 and A 219 mph for n = 1.0. Any eyewall bending wouldpermit
appreciably higher speeds; in fact, since ( p , - p c ) = 139 mb, theoretically
sufficient bending could explain any speed up to 244 mph for n = 0.5 and
345 mph for n = 1.0. If one again takes T,= 299.4"K,but now lets RH = 1.0,
one finds convergence for p , = 890 mb. Here zI = 57,500 ft, p , = 84 mb,
T,= 191.8"K. In addition, ( H / c , )=
~ 359.4"K; so an increase of about 16°K
in the total static temperature could explain any recorded hurricane wind
intensity without any eyewall bending if the sea level eyewall air were satu-
rated, and if a moist adiabat were taken to be an adequate approximation
t o the eyewall sounding. I n fact, increases above 16°K appear impossible
under these conditions as long as the sea surface is taken as an isothermal
42 FRANCIS E. FENDELL
I 1 I I 1
0 10 20 30 40 50
6)
FIG.13. The density versm altitude relation for each of the three thermodynamic
loci of Fig. 12 are presented. The density variations from ambient within the storm are
less than 30 %, and speeds are far below sonic everywhere.~ Ambient, ---moist
adiabat, dry adiabat.
surface. Of course, use of the moist adiabat for the entire eyewall and the
dry adiabat for the eye involves idealizations yielding upper estimates, but the
large magnitude of the winds so calculated suggests the ideas behind the
estimates are correct.
At this point a brief summary of the calculated results and their implication
seems apropos. Even though cumulonimbi occupy only 10 to 20 % of the
eyewall (Charney, 1971, pp. 358-359), results have been presented for moist
adiabatic ascent and hydrostatics in the eyewall which suggest that significant
pressure deficits relative to ambient may be achieved by moist adiabatic
ascent of air whose total static temperature (Hlc,) is increased by only 1 yo
over ambient, and very intense storms may be achieved by ascent of air with
a 5 yoincrease over ambient. The 5 yoincrease involves arbitrarily increasing
the eyewall relative humidity a t shipboard height to 100 yo from an ambient
level of 84 Yo, and it would seem more likely that the means by which the
winds of very intense hurricanes are achieved is that the eye-eyewall inter-
face, as well as it can be defined, slopes a t least slightly outward from the top
TROPICAL CYCLONES 43
1014 I I I I I I I
200 2M 240 260 280 330 320 340 360
T PK)
FIG.14. The three curves are analogous to those of Fig. 12, except that the moist
adiabat, while still taken to be based on ambient sea level values for relative humldity
and temperature, IS now computed from a n iteratively determined sea level pressure,
consistent with the definition of the top of the storm as an isobaric, isothermal surface
of constant altitude.~ Ambient, --- moist adiabat, --- dry adiabat.
of the inflow layer to the top of the storm. The calculation of wind speed for a
storm with an eye implicitly assumes suchsloping. Theadditionaldryadiabatic
compression-associated pressure deficit available to sustain swirling is reduced
if the eye-eyewall interface is vertical to a certain height, and only then slopes
outward; the additional pressure deficit is unavailable if the eye-eyewall
interface is perfectly vertical virtually to the top of the storm. (Whether or
not the eye-eyewall interface slopes outward does not alter the conceptual
thermodynamic stratification of the eye nor the sea level eye pressure deficit
from ambient.) Dissenting publications will now be discussed.
Malkus and Riehl(l960)find that moist adiabatic ascent of ambient sea level
air to the level of neutral buoyancy produces a sea level pressure of 1000 mb;
insufficient detail is presented to ascertain what precise calculation was con-
ducted. I n any case, such a pressure drop is insufficient t o sustain even a mod-
erate hurricane, and since these authors believe the eyeeyewall interface to
be virtually perfectly vertical, another means of achieving and sustaining winds
known to arise in hurricanes was required. The means ultimately postulated is
latent and sensible heat transfer from sea to air greatly in excess of ambient
transfer rates; the air ascending in the eyewall would then possess large
enough equivalent potential temperature to achieve the pressure deficits nec-
essary t o sustain even the highest known hurricane winds. The Riehl-Malkus
44 FRANCIS E. FENDELL
1010
900
700
h
n
9
n
500
100
0 10 20 30 40 50
(e)
FIG.15. In this replotting of Fig. 14, explicit pressure versus altitude curves for the
ambient, the moist adiabat taken t o characterize the eyewall, and the d r y adiabat
recompression taken to characterize the eye are presented. The moist adiabat is com-
puted by the iterative procedure described in the caption to Fig. 14. -Ambient,
-_- moist adiabat, dry adiabat.
extra oceanic heat source postulate will be examined below (Section 3.7-3.9).
Here it will be noted that even extrapolation of low-speed transfer coefficients
to extreme hurricane conditions could not justify the equivalent potential
temperature increases required by Riehl and Malkus; thus for very intense
hurricanes (only) an outward sloping of the eyewall was conceded by these
modelers. Such a procedure directly contradicts the conclusions of Shea
(1972), based on consideration of flight radar data; Shea finds that the eye-
eyewall interface slopes modestly outward for moderate hurricanes, but
questions whether it does so for intense hurricanes. However, radar data are
based on returns from precipitation and err on the side of verticality because
the strongest returns will come from the torrential rains of cumulonimbi,
rather than from weaker or decaying cumuli (Palm& and Newton, 1969, pp.
487491). Direct observational distinction between an interfacial slope of a
few degrees and no slope a t all, especially when some cloudiness may occur
in the eye, is difficult, and observational evidence can be cited t o support
either position. For instance, Palmen (1948) sketches an eyewall with ap-
preciable outward slope down t o nearly inflow-layer heights, based on obser-
TROPICAL CYCLONES 45
(18) v-q=o
(19) V(q"/2)+(Vxq) x q + 2 8 , x q = - ~ ~ - v V x ( V x q )
+
whcrc @ = ( p i p ) (ae +
x r)"/2 gz. the gravitational acceleration g = -g2,
+
the vrlocit'y in nonincrt,ial coordinates v =Re x r q, the component of the
rotat.ion of the earth normal t o the local tangent plane !& = fi2, and the Irine-
matic viscosity (later given eddy-diffusivity values) is v.
Nondimensionalizat,ion is effected by letting q' = q / ( Y o Q ) l ' z , 1)' =
@/(Y0Q), r' = r/(Y?o/Q)1’2, and E = v/Yo where the Ekman number E < 1
46 FRANCIS E. FENDELL
and Yocharacterizes the circulation away from the boundary (such as the
maximum swirl speed times the radius at which it occurs). Dropping primes,
one has
(20) v.q
(21) V(q72) + (V x q) x q +2k x q = -vp --EV x (V x q)
These equations are studied in axisymmetric cylindrical polar coordinates
(22) q=UP +vd + wk, r = rB + z &
Away from the boundary (i.e. in region I) the following expansions are
adopted:
(23) p=?r(r,z)+*.-, v= V(r,z)+-*-,
w = El'' W(r,z ) +- - ,
* u =O ( W / ~ )
Substitution of (23) in (20) and (21) gives the gradient wind equation:
(24) rrz=O, W,=O, rrr=2V + V2/r
Subscripts r and z here (and x and 5 below) denote partial differentiation.
The axially invariant solution is complete when ~ ( ror ) V ( r ) is specified
[here V ( r ) will be given]; W ( r ) is found by matching the solution to (24)
t o the solution for the frictional layer 11, and in this sense W ( r )is determined
by the boundary layer dynamics.
If 5 = zE-'la [which implies that the frictional layer is O(E1I2)in thickness]
and if near the boundary
(251 u = Ub(r, 5 ) f .'
* 2 2) = vb(r, 5) + ' '. ,
w = E'''Wb(r, 5 ) +. * ' , p =p b ( r , 5) + * ' ' ,
then the axial component of the momentum conservation equation degener-
ates to (ap,,/a()= 0 in conventional fashion, so the pressure field in the bound-
ary layer is known from (24). If
(26)
$=rub, Y=rV, $=rub, iZ=2-1/2wb , x = r2, I==21/25,
then in ternis of dimensional quantities $ = r u / Y o i,h = rv/Y,, tij = )
w / ( 2 Q ~ ) ~ [" =
, z/(v/2Q)'/', x = Qr'/Y,,; the boundary layer thickness is
O(U/Q)~/'.In terms of quantities introduced in (26), one has from (20) and
(21), upon dropping the tildes,
(271 +I + wy =0
(32) 4 = -[Y”(~)]sin(2-”~5)exp(
-2-1/25)
(34) +
w = 2-1/z[Yz(x)]{1- [ ~ i n ( 2 - ~ / ~ <cos(2-1~2~)][exp(-2-1~25)]}
)
Specifically what is sought is w(r, C-tco) = W ( r ) for Y ( r ) of interest.
For r large, from (34)
La
9
0.4
0.2
-0.06 I I I I I I I I
0 2 4 6 8 10 12 14 16 18
X
FIG.16. Nondimensionalresults for the frictional boundary layer obtained by the method of weighted residuals, from Dergarabedian
a d Fendell (1972b). The divergence w(z, 5 --f a)) and the volumetric flux 6 = -j." +(z,5) d[ are presented for the impressed swirl
'Y = 1 - x / z o , zo = 20, believed pertinent to a hurricane outside the eyewall. Except near the axis where nonlinear inertial effects
dominate, the linear Ekman layer result, w(z, 5 rn) =YZ/2lIa,is an excellent approximation to the numerical results. The volumetric
flux 8(z)is thus linearly proportional to (zo - z)to good approximation. Normalized residuals indicate large errors for a < 3, and
discount the premature eruption as an artifact of the method. The solution by Carrier (1971a)for small z indicates the adequacy of
the linear Ekman result for the divergence to within a factor of two. Since v t (1/76)milesa/hr and R = (1/16)rad/hr, dimensionally
the results imply the boundary layer is of thickness O ( V / R ) ~=/ 0 ~ ( 1 mile), the d o d u x into the boundary layer is ( 2 ~ R ) l ' ~ w ( z ,
5 + 00) = 0(6 x miles/hr), and the volumetric flux erupting up the eyewall is (2n-T,av/L2)1'a6(z) = 0 ( 7 x lo3 miles3/hr)where
'Yo characterizes the eyewall relative angular momentum per unit mass. The implication is that the fluid initially in the boundary
layer sustains the hurricane for about a week, and the fluid lying above the boundary layer (with supplementary replenishment of
moisture from the ocean) can readily sustain the hurricane for more than another week.
TROPICAL CYCLONES 49
3.6. The Energetics of the Frictional Boundary Layer and Throughput Supply
For the frictional boundary layer I1 and throughput I, Carrier et al. (1971)
take the following approximations as adequate for the quasi-steady mature
phase: (1)the Prandtl and Schmidt numbers are unity; (2) the hydrostatic
approximation holds; (3)the boundary layer approximation holds (derivatives
normal to the boundary exceed those tangential to the boundary, but velocity
components parallel to the boundary exceed those normal t o the boundary);
(4) the eddy transfer is adequately modeled by the laminar flux-gradient
relations for diffusion of mass, momentum, and heat (as given by Fick,
Newton, and Fourier, respectively), except that the augmented kinematic
(eddy) viscosity may vary with radial position (but not with axial position);
and (5) the mixture of dry air and water vapor may be taken as a perfect gas
with constant heat capacity over the range of temperatures of interest here.
I n view of the limited understanding of quantitative formulation of cumulus
convection and turbulent transfer, on the cyclone scale of interest here these
five approximations seem reasonable. Clearly the familiar Reynolds analogy,
together with the constancy of the eddy viscosity over most of the boundary
layer, is being adopted. It can then be shown that for L held constant, the
following equation, a generalization of those given by Crocco in fluid dynamics
and Shvab and Zel’dovich in combustion, holds in the meteorological context
of interest here :
with f (z) (to be discussed below) known. The H used throughout this section
is H , as defined in (3); the subscript t is dropped t o avoid double subscripts
below. The boundary-initial conditions are taken to be
(38) r = r o : H = Ha@)
where, again, ro is the outer edge of the storm and z1 is the top of the storm.
The ambient profile H,(z) is given; H , = HI = N,(z = zl)= Ha@= 0).
Taking H, = H,(z = 0) implies that for r > R (where R is the radius of the
eyewall), the ocean surface temperature is a constant and the water vapormass
fraction (which takes on its saturation value at the nominally plane sea
surface z = 0 ) is taken independent of pressure (see below). Since the thermal
conductivity of water greatly exceeds that of air, uniform sea surface tern-
perature appears to be a good approximation. That N,= H,(z = 0) follows
from the definition of the lid on the storm.
The terms, from left t o right, in (36) represent radial advection; axial
convection; turbulent diffusion and cumulus convection (both parameterized
in v, which will henceforth be treated as constant, though this is not nec-
essary); and radiation loss. Throughout I, and in I1 a t r = r,, , (36)may be
approximated as
(39) w ( a H / a ~-) V ( ~ ~ H /=
~ -?f (Zz ~) H)
this follows because +(z,,)= 0 [cf. (32)] and u(aH/ar) is negligible in I
[cf. (23)]. In view of the boundary conditionsf(z) must be chosen to permit
H ( z ) = Ha(z),where H,(z) is given (Jordan, 1957); Carrier et al., (1971) take
w(r, , z ) E wa(z) = 0, but there appears to be no need t o require this. Thus,
(40) w,(z)(~H,/~z)
- V(a2H,/ik2)= - f ( z ) H ,
(41) w aHpZ = 0
52 FRANCIS E. FENDELL
and the relevant boundary data for this hyperbolic suboperator is that given
a t z = 0 by (37). All this discussion, more carefully argued in Carrier et al.
(1971), leads to two significant results:
1. Throughout the frictional boundary layer and the throughput supply,
outside the eyewall the total stagnation enthalpy is approximately fixed
a t its ambient stratification. Furthermore, the small correction owing to
inertial effects in EL hurricane is readily seen to be a decrease of H with z
such that the enthalpy gradient a t z = 0 is increased slightly (about ten per-
cent or so).
2. In portions of the eyewall, the total stagnation enthalpy is, to good
approximation, constant at its sea level value, i.e. columns of air are very
nearly rising on a moist adiabat.
Numerical values of interest are the ambient net sealair enthalpy transfer
and the eddy viscosity (Carrier et al., 1971):
Because this result is not compatible with many existing hurricane models,
it becomes necessary to identify the reasons for disagreement. Hence in the
following sections the Riehl-Malkus theory is scrutinized.
It may be worth emphasizing that (36) yields a steady solution for the
frictional inflow layer with all inertial terms considered. It is not based on
obviously inadequate models of the f i o w layer, such as frictionless or purely
horizontal flow.
However, this result is really not quite so accurate as suggested by Carrier,
Hammond, and George, owing t o the omission of compressibility effects. A
decrease in gas density attends the decrease in gas pressure (of up to 12 %)
as one moves radially inward in the frictional inflow layer from the outer edge
toward the eyewall This decrease in air density is negligible for the dynamics,
but not the energetics. If the gas density decreases as one goes radially inward,
but the total stagnation enthalpy sea to air transfer remains approximately
a t the ambient rate (Carrier, 1971b, p. 158 footnote), then the vapor mass
fraction (ratio of vapor density to gas density) increases because there is less
mass to accept the same transfer. Carrier et al. (1971, p. 162) acknowledge the
effect, but fail to account for it in their calculations. It seems more appro-
priate to study the vapor density, which a t sea level depends only on sea
surface temperature, rather than the vapor mass fraction. A rough &st
estimate is that perhaps a 20 yoincrease over tropical ambient levels in latent
and sensible heat transfer from the ocean t o the atmosphere occurs near the
eyewall of hurricanes owing to this density reduction effect.
TROPICAL CYCLONES 53
While the exposition of the mature tropical cyclone has been given here in
terms of the Carrier model, most published works adopt the framework of the
Riehl-Malkus theory alluded to earlier (Riehl, 1954, 1963a; PalmBnandRiehl,
1957; Malkus, 1958, 1962; Malkus and Riehl, 1960; Riehl and Malkus, 1961).
The cornerstones of this theory have been summarized by Malkus (1962,
p. 232):
ascent rate of 0.7 mph. Thus air flows in through the boundary layer from
the outer edge of an open system, rather than sinking down into the frictional
layer as in Carrier's model. The boundary layer air, according to Malkus and
Riehl, undergoes adiabatic expansion as it spirals inward toward the center,
yet it remains isothermal. This requires a vast, rather localized increase in
sea-to-air transfer between the ocean and the contiguous atmosphere. That
the gradient normal to the air/sea interface of temperature and of water vapor
mass fraction is large enough to be consistent with vastly increased air/sea
transfer is accepted as possible:
I n the outskirts of a hurricane the temperature of the inflowing air drops slowly
due to adiabatic expansion during (horizontal) motion toward lower pressure. It is
one of the remarkable observations in hurricanes that this drop ceases at pressures
of 990-1000 mb and that thereafter isothermal expansion takes place. Presumably,
the temperature difference between sea and air attains a value large enough for the
oceanic heat supply to take place at a sufficient rate to keep the temperature
difference constant (Malkus and Riehl, 1960, p. 9).
The actual transports [between sea and air], of course, are very large in the
hurricane compared to the trades. Sensible heat pickup is 720 cal/cma/day, an
increase by a factor of 50 over the trades . . .; latent heat pickup is 2420 cal/cm2/day,
higher by a factor of 12-13 (Malkus and Riehl, 1960, p. 12).
'
From " Tropical Meteorology " by Herbert Riehl. Copyright 1954 by McGraw-Hill
Book Company. Used with permission.
TROPICAL CYCLONES 55
The Riehl-MaIkus theory that greatly augmented heat and mass transfer
sustains the tropical cyclone has, in fact, been parameterized into all
existing computer simulations (see Section 3.10). For example, Rosenthal
(1971b) closely reflects the Riehl-Malkus theory and notes similar logic in
the work of another computer modeler of tropical cyclones (Ooyama, 1969):
Air-sea exchanges of sensible and latent heat have long been considered impor-
tant ingredients in the development and maintenance of tropical storms. Palmbn
(1948) showed, on a climatological basis, that tropical storms form primarily over
warm ocean waters (TSes > 26°C). Malkus and Riehl (1960) showed that the deep
central pressures associated with hurricanes could not be explained hydrostatically
unless the equivalent potential temperature, 8., in the boundary layer was 10”t o
15°K greater than t h a t of the mean tropical atmosphere. Byers (1944) pointed
out that the observed near-isothermal conditions for inward spiraling air in the
hurricane boundary layer required a source of sensible heat t o compensate for the
cooling due to adiabatic expansion. . . .
Ooyama (1969) fround drastic reductions in the strength of his model storm when
the air-sea exchanges of sensible and latent heat were suppressed. He pointed out
that at sufficiently large radii, the boundary layer is divergent (the so-called Ekman
.
layer “sucking”). .. This subsidence tends t o decrease the boundary layer 8.
since 88,/8z < 0 in the lower troposphere. Ooyama argued that unless the energy
supply from the oaean can again raise the 8. of the boundary layer air t o sufficiently
large values before the inflowing air reaches the inner region, the convective activity
will diminish in those regions and, hence, the storm will begin to weaken.
Ooyama’s line of reasoning can be extended to show that evaporation is far more
important than sensible heat flux. The air sucked into the boundary layer has a
higher potential temperature than the original boundary layer air. The subsiding
air has a smaller 8, only because it is relatively dry. (Rosenthal, 1971b, p. 772).
3.8. The Intensity of a Tropical Cycbne and the Underlying Sea Surface
Temperature
Palmen and Riehl (1957, p. 156) state: “Evidently, a cyclone will decay
rapidly if it encounters thermally unfavorable conditions. The generation
term in [the equation for conservation of kinetic energy] w ill then decrease
rapidly; it will become negative if the air ascending in the core is cooler than
the surroundings in spite of release of latent heat. This would happen when a
storm moves over a relatively cold ocean surface, over a continent, or when
colder air masses invade the cyclone near the surface.”
I n discussing the Riehl-Malkus theory, one should distinguish between what
these authors themselves assert, and what others citing their work have added.
For example, Shuleykin (1970,1972)goes beyond Riehl andMalkus andasserts
that the “. . . power of the hurricane . . . increases sharply with the tem-
perature of the underlying water surface ” (Shuleykin, 1972, p. 1).However,
attempts to correlate central pressure deficit and sea surface temperature,
without sufficient account of other factors, seems simplistic. This particular
point will be now discussed.
56 FltLLNCIS E. FENDELL
3
-s
10107-
1000-. .' I I
..
a
1 . I 1. a
1.0 I -
-50
n
$2
y
2
Ln
990-
980-
a
a
. -668
-81
5
4
. . .
y
n
970- -93
a
960- -102 3
2
Y .*
2 950- -111 g
2
9 940 - a - 120 5
930- -128 5
3 920- -136 3
z
2 910- -143 ,D
$ 900- -149 ;
;
a
'1
1WOt \
\
995 - -
990- -
dLI m 985 -
3
I-
80 975 -
970 -
21
211 I 22 23 24 25 26 27 28
965
102 202' 06, lkz 'i2z 1z
: 2k d8z 1Lz I d4z lk, dlz lbz 2bz' d6z Ikz Id22 1!2z 222
FIG.18. The central sea level pressure is plotted as a function of the local sea surface temperature for Hurricane Ginny, 21-28
October 1963, which passed over the Gulf Stream on 24 October (from Perlroth, 1967, p. 266). Solid line indicates extrapolated
temperature reading besed on composite sea surface temperature chart, 11-19 October, 1963.
58 FRANCIS E. FENDELL
Finally, the fact that hurricanes leave cold wakes in the ocean might suggest
that they do drain the upper sea layers of heat. However, the reason for the
sea surface temperature dropping about two degrees Centigrade after hur-
ricane passage is the upwelling of lower, colder water owing to convection
currents induced in the ocean by the pressure deficits of the hurricane
(Perlroth, 1967). Slow-movingintense tropical cyclones can cause upwelling,
from depths of 40 to 65 m, within the radius of hurricane force winds;
compensatory downwelling of as much as 80 to 100 m occurs 45 to 110 n miles
from the path of the storm (Revesz, 1971; Leipper, 1967). The warm ocean
water near the center of the hurricane flows radially outward, and is replaced
by colder water from lower depths; outside 65 n miles from the center, below
the outflow, there is compensatory inflow toward the center of the hurricane
t o complete the convection cell (Leipper, 1967; Wright, 1969).
Leipper finds the temperatue readings a t depths in the outer portion of the
hurricane path t o be higher than the temperatures before the storm. Thus a
significant portion of the heat of the upper layers would seem to be trans-
ported radially outward, vertically downward, and then radially inward.
Leipper and Wright, however, postulate that all the heat of the relatively
warm upper oceanic level in excess of that of the colder upwelling is trans-
ferred to the atmosphere as an augmentation of the ambient rate8; Leipper
suggests a transfer rate of 4500 cal/cm2-day under Hurricane Hilda (1964),
I n this regard deductions from data taken off Barbados in August 1968 may be of
interest (Warsh, 1973). Warsh characterizes the convective activity of the tropical
atmosphere on a given day in terms of graduated modes, ranging from mode one (severely
depressed convection with almost no cumulus) to mode six (severely enhanced convection
with mostly cumdonimbi and heavy showers). Warsh finds the sensible heat flux from
the ocean t o the atmosphere increases only extremely slightly from mode one t o mode six.
In contrast, the latent heat flux decreases t o one-half in magnitude from mode one to
mode four, then increases from mode four t o mode six to nearly its mode one magnitude.
Since the equivalent potential temperature in a mode six atmosphere is almost every-
where 335°K or higher, and since the latent heat flux from the sea in a mode six atmos-
phere is still less than the equivalent of one-half centimeter of evaporated water per
day, the results would not seem to augur well for a sometimes postulated order of magni-
tude increase in latent heat transfer over ambient levels under even a severe storm.
Ostapoff et al. (1973) also deduce, from oceanographic observations in the ITCZ during
a broad light rainfall from cumuli, that the latent heat transfer was appreciably reduced
owing to high humidities, but the sensible heat transfer was somewhat increased, with
the result that the Bowen ratio had an average value of about 0.2 (over twice the tropical
norm), and a maximum value of 0.247. Finally, even though the measurements were
taken over free water surfaces in the laboratory or over lakes a t low wind speeds, the
results of Easterbrook (1969) are interesting as further evidence that intuitive expecta-
tions about latent heat transfer can err. Easterbrook finds that the vortical wind patterns
created by waves on free water surfaces can suppress vertical turbulent transport of
water vapor and reduce evaporation, such that larger height-to-period ratios for surface
waves can lead to smaller mass transfer across the two-phase interface.
TROPICAL CYCLONES 59
is largely cloud-free, and the same adiabatic expansion taken as dry produces
a 7.3”Cdrop. Such a large temperature drop does not occur (though whether
the static temperature is really constant as Riehl believes is uncertain), and
should never have been expected. But Riehl (1954, p. 286) was surprised at
measurements he interpreted to imply constant static temperature during
inflow in the frictional layer, and passed immediately from the (clearly in-
appropriate) isentropic expansion to the postulate of latent and sensible heat
transfer from the ocean greatly in excess of ambient transfer 1evels.O
3.9.1. Evaluating the Arguments for Greatly Augmented Enthalpy Transfer.
There are no indisputable semiempirical theories or direct measurements of
the heat and mass transfer from the ocean to the atmosphere in a hurricane:
“unfortunately there is little information on C , (‘ the nondimensional co-
efficientfor the air-sea energy interchange ’) under hurricane conditions, other
than the semispeculative guess that the exchange coefficientsof latent heat,
sensible heat, and momentum are probably of the same magnitude ” (Ooyama,
1969, p. 15). Hidy (1972, pp. 1086 and 1097) notes the lack of quantitative
progress on air-sea transfer, cites the paucity of data on the drag coefficient
at sea level for winds over 20 mph, and mentions the difficulties in extra-
polating data accurately; in fact, one of few known results casts doubt on the
validity of the Reynolds analogy relating turbulent transfer of heat and
momentum at the air-sea interface. There have been attempts to extrapolate
to hurricane conditions empircal laws relating ocean evaporation rates to
wind speed. The actual measurements refer to low wind speed and involve
relatively dry air, far from saturation; extrapolation to hurricane winds and
nearly saturated low-level tropical air is unjustified and misleading. Garstang
(1967)emphasizesthat a critical assumption in the theory of Riehl and Malkus
is that the sea-to-air transfer coefficients increase linearly with wind speed
indefinitely into the hurricane regime. Zipser (1969, p. 813) found that using
such linearly extrapolated bulk turbulent transfer relations, which imply
an order of mapitude increase in latent heat transfer under moderately
strong tropical disturbances over the ambient rate of transfer, would have
produced clouds in an observed tropical disturbance with unsaturated con-
vective downdrafts on a time scale an order of magnitude too short. Zipser
also notes that Riehl and Malkus expected downdrafts around cumulonimbi
Kraus emphasizes that the Riehl-Malkus theory depends on an isothermal inflow
layer and discusses whether frictional effects are fully accounted for in that theory:
“The importance of [an] additional energy supply to air in the hurricane, before it
ascends ill the warm core, was stressed particularly by Malkus and Riehl (1960). The
argument would be weakened somewhat if a (verbal) suggestion by Carrier was found
to be true, Carrier maintains that surface friction must cause a deceleration and compres-
sion of a surface air parcel along its trajectory; this compression compensates to some
extent for the expansion that would be associated otherwise with the externally imposed
pressure reduction” (&am, 1972, p. 208).
TROPICAL CYCLONES 61
compensate for rain-out in the outer spiral bands such that by the time a
particle has slowly sunk into the boundary layer a t 0.005 mph, i t has been
enriched in total stagnation enthalpy to the ambient value a t its current height.
I n other words, much of the sea-to-air transfer of latent and sensible heat
continues to pass across the boundary layer with little diminution, just as
in the ambient, such that the enthalpy of air originally in the 700900 mb
strata increases t o that of air originally in the boundary layer owing to en-
richment of its total static enthalpy as it slowly descends. Only as the hurri-
cane leaves the tropical oceans is this ambient transfer reduced; the air
entering the boundary layer eventually is of lower total static enthalpy,
since it comes from air which is originally higher in the tropical ambient
(hence colder and drier), and since that air is not appreciably enriched as it
descends. I n this way traverse over ocean patches of varying temperature can
help cause the well known nonmonotonic perturbations in hurricane intensity
within the general level of strength computed from the spawning ambient as
discussed earlier (see also Section 4.4).
I n this critique of the Riehl-Malkus model, one should note a later modifi-
cation of earlier statements. Malkus and Riehl (1960, p. 17) write: “The
total added heat energy from the ocean is on the order (for the moderate
storm) of 2.5 cal/gm, while the average normal heat content (latent plus
sensible) of tropical air is about 80 cal/cm.” Thus the enthalpy contribution
added by the ocean to ambient air enthalpy is about three percent for a
moderate storm. “ The heat . . . gained by the air is only a minute fraction
of that carried inward through the cylinder a t the distance of the 1OOO-mb
isobar . . . Nevertheless, it is these small increments that produce the strong
inward warming. . . . They are thus of utmost importance for generation and
maintenance of tropical storms, even though they may be wholly neglected in
a general energy balance. . . .” (Palm& and Riehl, 1957, p. 156). That such a
marginal amount of heating is critical to both generation and maintenance
seems intuitively surprising. Later Malkus (1962, pp. 247-249) limited the
role of greatly augmented enthalpy transfer strictly to the maintenance of
the hurricane, since during development the high winds that supposedly
permit the increased turbulent transfer do not exist.
Hawkins and Rubsam (1968) have computed the structure and budgets
for Hurricane Hilda for October 1, 1964, when it was an intense storm over
the Gulf of Mexico. An unprecedented five-level collection of data was avail-
able for exhaustive analysis, and the total static enthalpy budget was cal-
culated very similarly t o the approach used by Malkus and Riehl (1960).
Hawkins and Rubsam found, however, that (upon inclusion of the postulated
latent and sensible enthalpy flux from the sea) the amount of energy estimated
t o be radiated away from the top of the storm was twenty times what seems
physically possible. The kinetic energy budget computed for Hilda was also
TROPICAL CYCLONES 63
a t significant variance from the one computed by Riehl and Malkus (1961)
for Hurricane Daisy (1958). I n view of this, Leipper's (1967) suggestion that
the oceanic heat transfer to Hilda would be underestimated, using Malkus's
formulas, by 50-90 yoseems incomprehensible.
-
4°C; this amount is in excess of one percent of both the static temperature
( 300°K) and also the total stagnation temperature ( 350°K) for the sea
N
both before and after a typhoon; but when the station is under typhoon in-
fluence, a reduction of the maximum temperature by about 3°C occurs, while
the minimum temperature remains the same." If by maximum and minimum
temperatures Deppermann means dry-bulb and wet-bulb temperatures,
respectively, and if one assumes Deppermann correctly accounted for the
dynamic contribution (qa/2cp),then Deppermann finds that the static tem-
perature T decreases by about 3°K in a typical typhoon, while the total
stagnation temperature increases by a few degrees Centigrade (5'4°C a t the
very most). I n any case, there is no evidence of large increases in (Hlc,), as
an oceanic heat source would allegedly cause. Also, if (Hlc,) is roughly
radially constant in the inflow layer, then a decrease in T of about 3.7"C
from sea level autumnal tropical ambient is necessary for condensation, and
this is reportedly not achieved in a typical typhoon, so a cloud-free frictional
inflow layer is no surprise in Carrier's model.
Arakawa (1954, p. 119) reported that the air temperature dropped 1°C
from 28°C to 27"C, and the wet-bulb temperature remained about constant
radially at approximately 26.5"C, during the passage of a n 898 mb typhoon
over a Japanese weather ship in October 1944; only in the eye did the two
temperatures rise sharply. Winds rose t o about 120 mph in the eyewall.
Again, this seems compatible with the Carrier-Hammond-George predictions,
which include no oceanic heat transfer within hurricanes much above ambient
level. Palm& and Newton (1969, p. 478) assert with no elaboration that the
measurement implies an increase of the equivalent potential temperature
from 360" to 385"K, and thus is a confirmation of the internal heat source
postulate; the author does not understand how this result was achieved.
To avoid difficulties in boundary layer measurements, Riehl (1963a,
p. 277) studied equivalent potential temperatures deduced from aircraft
data taken a t the 245-250 mb level a t the inner edge of the eyewall. Little
complication from moisture is expected a t such heights, and the variation of
equivalent potential temperature with height is not expected t o be large.
Riehl reports equivalent potential temperature of 370°K for a hurricane of
central pressure of 960 mb, but provides no further details on the instrument-
ation or data reduction whatever. If the result is correct, very significant
evidence exists for an oceanic heat source. However, Dr. R. H. Simpson of the
National Hurricane Center in Miami, Florida has informed the author that a
vortex thermometer was used (private correspondence). I f one recalls that
250 mb corresponds very roughly t o approximately 35,000 ft, then the remarks
of Gentry (1964, p. 12) are illuminating: " The wind tunnel tests of the vortex
probe under icing conditions (Ruskin and Schecter . . .) indicated that the
recorded temperature might be too high due to the change of state on impact
a t probe entry. . . . No evidence is readily available as t o whether much ice
accumulated on the vortex probe of the aircraft flying a t about 35,000 f t or
TROPICAL CYCLONES 65
y = PvlP
(43) +
= dRH)P(T)/Cp, a(RH)P(T)I
G o(RH)P(T ) / p
so the vapor mass fraction Y increases as the relative humidity R H increases
or as the total pressure p decreases, for temperature T fixed. I n the autumnal
tropical ambient, if L represents latent heat of condensation plus glaciation,
at sea level (LYIc,) G 50°K. The ambient sea level relative humidity is 0.84
and the pressure is 1014 mb. [The relative humidity is unity a t the air-sea
interface but sea level measurement generally means readings a t shipboard
height, or more phenomenologically, it means measurement in the postulated,
roughly thirty foot thick constant-stress layer near the air-sea interface
(Hidy, 1972, p. 1084).] For a moderate hurricane with central pressure of
966 mb, the increase in (Hlc,) is 2.5"K, and for an intense hurricane with
central pressure of 910 mb, the increase in ( H / c p )is 5.7"K-provided R H is
held a t 0.84. If R H increases from 0.84 t o unity under the eyewall, then ( H / c p )
increases by 12.5"K for the moderate hurricane and 16.3"K for an intense
hurricane-although the justification for adopting such an increase in R H
appears unestablished, and Anthes and Johnson (1968, p. 297) cite evidence
66 FRANCIS E. FENDELL
that the relative humidity of the boundary layer tends t o remain between
80 and 90 yo.Malkus and Riehl (1960, p. 16) claim the equivalent potential
temperature, which is clearly closely related to (Hiep),increases by 12'5°K
from ambient to eyewall in the moderate hurricane [although Riehl (1963a,
p. 277) seems to augment this t o 16"K], and by 35°K in the intense
hurricane. By the reasoning adopted here the physical basis of the 12.5"K
increase becomes evident, but the 35°K increase for an intense hurricane
represents a physically impossible relative humidity of over 100 yo. Suc-
cinctly, while Carrier and his co-workers discuss increases in the first normal
derivative of H at sea level in hurricanes over ambient on the order of 10 yo,
Riehl and Malkus discuss occasional increases in H itself on the order of 10 %.
Carrier and his co-workers neglected the full effect of decreased air density as
the eyewall is approached, and found H t o be radially constant; the conject-
ure here is that the error in H so incurred is about one percent or so.
1°Black and Mallinger (1972, p. 64) characterize most models as giving a 60%
reduction in maximum wind speed for a 2°C drop in sea surface temperature. Doubt
concerning such sensitive dependence of hurricane intensity on sea surface temperature
was discussed in Section 3.8. Rocent,lythe existence of a closed oceanic convection cell
induced by hurricane winds, already discussed,has been further confirmed by additional
TROPICAL CYCLONES 69
*l Typically five runs of the kind described, at two-hour intervals, starting from the
radius of maximum winds and proceeding radially away from the center, characterize the
so-called eyemod experiment. Most of the discussion is oriented toward this type of
experiment. However, it may be noted that the seeding of Hurricane Ginger (1971) dis-
cussed below was a so-called rainsector experiment: all the water-containing clouds in a
45" sector from 50 to 100 n miles from the center are seeded a t about 22,000 f t to divert
low-level inflow to premature eruption and high-level outflow outside the eyewall, with
resultant dispersal of latent heat energy over a wider region of the storm (Hawkins et al.,
1972). I n concept, a rainsector experiment consists of four fifty-minute seedings, at fifty-
minute intervals. The reason a reinsector, rather than eyemod, experiment was attempted
on Ginger was that it was a large diffuse storm (moderate gale winds out to 260 n miles,
circulation out to 400 n miles) with only a n ill-defined eyewall (maximum winds of about
60-70 knots at 40 t o 60 n miles from the center).
TROPICAL CYCLONES 71
270). One accepted point is that seeding in the nascent eye of a developing
tropical storm should be avoided since this procedure would probably abet
intensification (Rosenthal, 1971a). The most recent proposal has been t o seed
cumuli outside the eyewall and above the 0°C isotherm (roughly, 600 mb or
15,000 ft) with silver iodide. (Of course, it is more difficult to find seedable
clouds, and there is a greater expanse to cover, outside the eyewall.) The
aim is not to capitalize directly upon the heat of fusion released by supercooled
water droplet freezing, but rather to cause these cumuli outside the eyewall
to grow several thousand feet in height from midtropospheric to upper tropo-
spheric levels. This would hopefully initiate a chain of events from which
an order of magnitude more heat than that associated with freezing will
indirectly be realized. This added heat would come from some low-level in-
flowing warm moist air erupting not up the eyewall, but prematurely up the
growing cumulus, with associated condensation and additional glaciation. If
entirely successful, proponents have suggested that perhaps a substitute
eyewall further from the center, and hence (from conservation of angular
momentum) with reduced swirling speeds, could be realized from this pre-
maXure eruption of boundary layer air (Gentry and Hawkins, 1971; Rosenthal,
1971~).
Fukuta (1972) suggests that the field experiments conducted to date have
employed overseeding of supercooled water droplets to form small ice parti-
cles; the energy release would be small and the effect over in less than half an
hour. Instead, Fukuta suggests reducing the seeding material to 1 yo or even
0.1 yo of that used in past field experiments, t o form large precipitable ice
particles. The latent heat of fusion these falling particles could extract
from the inflow-updraft stream would supposedly raise the central pressure
for hours, reduce swirling, and induce spreading out of the storm. A detailed
analysis fully substantiating either the concepts of Gentry and Hawkins or
the concepts of Fukuta has not appeared.
Clearly, like numerical simulation of hurricanes, the seeding of hurricanes
warrants an entire review unto itself. I n fact, with the proposed extension of
the U S . seeding effort [Project Stormfury, a joint effort of the Department
of Commerce (NOAA) and the Department of Defense (Navy)], from the
western North Atlantic to the western North Pacific Oceans (Mallinger, 1971),
this might be an apt time for such a review.
Attention will be confined here to a few observations, especially to what the
hurricane models suggest about the seeding procedure.
Even proponents of seeding anticipate only a 10 t o 15% decrease in
maximum winds. I n the one case in which larger decreases were noted, the
anomaly is now attributed to synoptic peculiarities relating t o upper level
outflow (Hawkins, 1971). This is not to disparage such decreases; statistical
treatment of a model suggests multimillion dollar annual savings in damage
72 FRANCIS E. FENDELL
from hurricane seedings that would reduce peak winds by Gfteen percent
(Boyd et al., 1971). The problem is that the storm is naturally oscillating in
intensity by the same order of magnitude, so it is very difficult to distinguish
natural and artificially induced changes. I n fact, the gradual increase of the
maximum winds of Hurricane Ginger by 15 yo during the day after initial
seeding on September 26, 1971 was ascribed to natural forces by Project
Stormfury personnel, as was the 11% decrease after the second seeding on
September 28 (Lieb, 1972). Fujita (1972) could find no evidence that seeding
altered Ginger; since the central pressure of this weak hurricane was only
980 mb at %he times of seeding, he suggests that perhaps the cloud-top
heights were too low for the silver iodide to be effective.The threat of litigation
has constrained the number of seeding experiments severely.
The National Hurricane Research Laboratory (Gentry, 1969a,b, 1970)
has discussed a six t o twelve-hour cycle of amelioration after seeding; a
physical basis for this time scale has yet t o come forth (see below). Further, if
the central pressure deficit is reduced as reported, eyewall seeding must alter
the eye in a still unidentified manner, although Black et al. (1972) suggest
that one hour after seeding outside the eye, the eye may expand more than
is consistent with natural variability. More complete post-seeding probing
of the tropical cyclone would be helpful in evaluating these claims.
Rather similar computer models have produced different guidance with
regard to current seeding practice. The reasons for the discrepancy are not
fully available because some details remain unpublished. Rosenthal (1971~)
notes that both the magnitude and the duration of the heating taken t o
simulate seeding in his computer experiments seem excessively large. Never-
theless, in those numerical experiments believed t o most closely simulate the
field experiments performed on Hurricane Debby, August 18 and 20, 1969,
Rosenthal (19714 predicts an increase after seeding in the maximum wind,
and over wide radial extents an augmentation in wind level, a t 700 mb; the
comparable measurements a t 12,000 f t indicated a reduction in winds (Haw-
kins, 1971). Rosenthal predicts a decrease in the maximum wind a t sea level
after seeding (though in substantial portions of the hurricane, surface winds
are predicted t o increase); no post-seeding measurements were made a t sea
level. Quantitative detail is omitted here because Rosenthal (1971a, p. 415)
notes: ". . .at best, the results should be considered qualitative guidance material."
Sundqvist (1972) finds his numerical model predicts an increase in maximum
winds from silver iodide seeding, which serves to release more effectively the
latent heat in clouds below 0°C; the increase is about 10 % if seeding is carried
out in the region of intense convection. Within 20 hr of cessation of seeding,
the storm is predicted t o return to its preseeding state; seeding does not
initiate a cascade of effects that permanently alters the storm. Estoque (1971,
p. 4), noting the tentative nature of his conclusions, remarks:
TROPICAL CYCLONES 73
Seeding to divert a path seemingly holds little better promise than seeding
to alleviate intensity, since there appears to be no way to discern what path
alterations were due t o human intervention under current understanding.12
l 2 Dr. R. Cecil Gentry, director of the National Hurricane Research Laboratory and
of Project Stormfury, stated recently that budgetary reductions had grounded the four
aircraft used in cloud-seeding experiments, and probably no full-scale attempts a t
hurricane modification would be undertaken in the next three years (Anonymous, 1973).
If and when seeding of hurricanes is resumed around 1976 perhaps activities will be ex-
tended to the North Pacific where more storms suitable for seeding occur annually.
74 FRANCIS E. FENDELL
Gray (1973)is also pessimistic about the effectivenessof silver iodide seeding
to modify hurricanes artificially, especially since such seeding can be directly
effective only as long as the lifetime of the cumulus cloud. Others have pro-
posed the alternative of spreading evaporation retardants on tropical oceans
to weaken incipient tropical cyclones (Gentry, 1969a), or even to preclude
hurricanes altogether; casting aside questions about the survivability of such
thin layers in the ocean and about pollution, one must wonder whether or not
fewer, but more violent, hurricanes would result, since the storms may well
play an essential (often, humanly beneficial) role in global energy and water
substance transport. Since the damage from a hurricane in the United States
tends to increase faster than the fourth power of the maximum sustained
surface wind speed (Howard et al., 1972), and since (by extrapolation from
data on typhoons inthenorthwesternPacific) twenty percent of hurricaneshave
wind speedsin excess of 120mph, a thirty percent reduction of maximum hurri-
canewindspeed remainsa very desirable goal. Gray ( 1973)believes a more safely
executed and more effective (if more expensive) means of attaining such a goal
than by silver iodide seeding is by dispersal of two to three million pounds of
0.1 p sized carbon particles in the surface fiictional layer at radial distances
outside the outflow level cirrus shield (which extends out generally about 200
miles from the center for moderately severe storms) but inside the surround-
ing anticyclone circulations (which typically border the outer edge of the
hurricane on the poleward side while in the trades). The carbon black dust
(Downie, 1960; Frank, 1973)is envisioned to cause O.5"-l0C heating per hour
for ten hours over an area of 40,000-80,000 kmawhen dispersed to a 10 yo
areal coverage, because it absorbs 15 yo of the solar radiation daily incident
on the tropical surface and then rapidly transmits the heat by conduction
to adjacent air flowing at low altitudes into the hurricane. Ideally, the result-
ing 5"-1OoC rise in air temperature increases buoyancy in the frictional bound-
ary layer, and the consequent convection leads to a dry downdraft which
inducesan increase in moisture flux from the ocean to the surface inflow layer.
The result is hopefully that about ten percent of the mass inflow (whichwould
reach the base of the eyewall from the edge of the cirrus shield in a day and a
half or so) prematurely erupts, and the maximum wind speeds in the eyewall
are significantlyreduced on the time scale of about one day. Thus, the ultimate
effect sought is that envisioned by Gentry and Hawkins (1971),but the means
employed differs. Rosenthal's numerical model (Rosenthal, 1970, 1971a,b,c)
predicts such a carbon dust seeding strategy will succeed in lowering the
maximum wind speed, although rainfall and wind levels in the outer portion
of the storm will increase. Three possible difficulties, besides expense of the
operation, are dispersal problems owing to clumping of the carbon particles
(whichmight be difficult to counter cheaply and without performance degmd-
ation); anticipating the storm path (so the particles remain outside the cirrus
TROPICAL CYCLONES 75
shield for ten hours but then flow into the storm, especially into the particularly
severe right-hand semicircle with respect to a n observor looking along the
path) ; and being certain midtropospheric moisture levels a t surface pressures
of 995-1005 mb (where the cirrus shield often ends) can sustain tall aumulo-
nimbi towers (otherwise, according to the Carrier model, the energy-enriched
erupting air eventually returns to the surface layer and proceeds inward to
the eyewall, perhaps t o intensify the storm).
CYCLONEINTENSIFICATION
4. THEORYOF TROPICAL
becomes lighter and lighter, relative to a column of air a t the outer edge of
the storm. This paragraph contains those points of Carrier's intensification
model that seem most unsettling, and will be subject t o close scrutiny in the
critique below.
However, Carrier's basic proposition is that the swirling in T has led to a
downflux into 11, a spiraling inward in the boundary layer and an upflux into
the core, and a lightenng of the core by hydrostatic considerations. For
dynamic consistency, the centrifugal force (anticipated to be the dominant
inertial effect) must increase t o balance the augmented radial pressure grad-
ient. Since angular momentum is conserved in I, where friction is negligible,
the fluid particles must necessarily move in closer t o the axis of symmetry
(axis of rotation). The result is that in time, in the Rankine-vortex-like swirl
distribution, the maximum azimuthal speed increases in magnitude and the
position of the maximum lies closer to the axis (Figs. 19 and 20). Hence, the
more the pressure falls in the core, the more fluid sinks into the boundary
layer t o spiral inward, erupt upward, and cause further pressure reduction
in the core. If the crucial early competition is resolved in favor of the organ-
ized convection, ultimately the particles erupting out of the boundary layer
rise so quickly that they lie on a moist adiabat, and the greatly lightened core
is entirely flushed of its original fluid.
While most descriptions (Palmbn and Newton, 1969) tend to picture the eye
as formed gradually as the pressure deficit develops, in the Carrier model the
central core may well be competely flushed of ambient-like air, so that the air
in the core lies on a moist adiabat, before much trace of an eye is to be found.
At Grst, a Rankine-vortex-like swirl holds everywhere. From this fully devel-
oped one-cell structure with a t most only the rudiments of an eye, a well-
defined two-cell structure with a calm center region emerges rapidly, probably
in much less than an hour, owing to inertial oscillation, in the following way.
As the pressure falls in the core relative to the ambient, the particles in I
necessarily move in closer to the axis t o permit a compensating centrifugal
force t o develop. Once the core is flushed and moist adiabatic ascent character-
izes the full height of the core, no further pressure deficit can be generated. By
inertia, the spinning particles continue t o move in, a dynamic imbalance is
created, and a radial acceleration develops t o force the particles away
from the axis of symmetry. This reverse motion creates a rarefaction a t the
center, and relatively dry warm motionless air sinks down the axial column
to form an eye. This air may be air from above the storm or rained-out, slowly
swirling air entrained out of the top of the moist adiabatic column (Fig. 21).
Because there is no appreciable swirl (hence no associated pressure gradient)
in the eye, there is no frictional boundary layer under the eye. The moist
adiabatic column becomes an annulus displaced from the axis,i.e., the eyewall;
the inertial oscillations of the eyewall eventually damp in time.
78 FRANCIS E. FENDELL
"TfrI
ill"
I
Cl--------- c
0 R r r
*
0 R
FIG. 19. In this schematic view by Carrier of the flow configuration and circum-
ferential velocity distribution in an intensifying tropical depression at some early
time t = tl (say), the interface C-C between the new and initial air in the core is idealized
as horizontal for convenience. However, it is easy t o show that for all but very modest
circulations (i.e. except for angular velocities less than three times the ambient), a rigidly
rotating core (which implies uniform updraft vdocity a t the top of the nonlinear frictional
layer) could not accept all the fluid pumped through the Ekman boundary layer. Thus a
uniform ascent in the core is dynamically impossible, and in fact ascent in the eyewall is
concentrated in cumulonimbi. For the gross balances being discussed, many points can
be made without accounting for such refinements in eyewall structure, though ultimately
details of the structure are crucial. (From Carrier, 1971b, p. 146.)
c
0 R r r
Fro. 20. Intensification from tropical depression to hurricane has progressed to a more
advanced stage in this schematic diagram, holding at t = t2 > t l , according to Carrier's
model. The magnitude of the maximum swirl is increased and its position lies closer to the
axis of symmetry. (From Carrier, 1971b, p. 148.)
I I
0 R r a
FIG.21. Schematic picture by Carrier of the flow configurationwhich prevails when the
radius of maximum swirl R is increasing and an incompletely formed eye is being filled
with relatively dry and motionless air, which sinks down from the top of the storm under
dry adiabatic compression. With the formation of an eye lighter in weight than the
eyewall, the terminal stages of intensification and the beginnings of quasi-steady
mature stage structure are realized. (From Carrier, 1971b, p. 150.)
This statement is true a t the outset and, if a hurricane forms, a t the end, of
flushing the core. I n fact, however, such a simplification lets a hurricane
always be formed. I n truth, the pressure fall for small times is less than that
predicted by the fractional-volume proportionality. As the quasi-steady
mature state approaches, the initially slow pressure fall probably accelerates
t o a rapid decrease, and the thermodynamic stratification of the emerging
eyewall asymptotically approaches a near moist adiabat state.
The problem cannot be satisfactorily buried in parameterizations of
turbulent transfer, radiative cooling, and cumulus convection in the core.
What appears needed is explicit recognition that a broad uniform ascent in
the core does not account for the actual mechanism of convection, which
would seem t o entail ascent in a concentrated number of intensified cumulo-
nimbi. The somewhat tentative nature of this remark stems from statements
like that by Palmkn and Newton (1969, p. 490): “It seems clear from . . .
observations and from descriptions of turbulent encounters that, in some
cyclones, ascent in the inner region is dominated by cumulonimbus, . . . while
in others a’broad-scale and more uniform ascent takes place.”
If cumulonimbi do play an essential role in the core ascent during intensi-
fication, some semblance of an eye would probably form a t an earlier stage
of hurricane development than Carrier suggests.l4 The eye would probably
not be entirely created on a time scale of 20 min a t the end of intensification,
as Carrier suggests, although inertial oscillations a t the end of intensification
might rapidly delineate a previously ill-defined eye.
The tritium-tracing analyses by Ostlund (1968) of Hurricane Hilda (1964)
and Hurricane Betsy (1965) suggest that while the eye may have partially
consisted of air entrained from the eyewall, there had been substantial sub-
sidence of stratospheric air down into the eye. Thus, Carrier seems correct
in citing two possible sources for the air in the eye.
l4 Consistent with his conception that i t is the compressional heating of the compen-
satory downdraft that warms the air, because heat directly released by cumulus con-
vection is almost entirely expended in raising the buoyant column, Gray (Shea, 1972,
pp. 118-122) suggests that turbulent diffusion and mixing convey heat from the eye to
warm the eyewall.
l6 From “Introduction to the Atmosphere” by Herbert Riehl. Copyright 1972 by
McGraw-Hill Book Company. Used with permission.
82 FBANCIS E. FENDELL
(46)
and
(47)
TROPICAL CYCLONES 83
These equations hold in 0 < r 5 T o , 0 < z < z1 where, again, z1 is the top of
the storm (a slippery lid) and ro is the outer edge. The boundary-initial
conditions of relevance here are
(48) r = r,: u = y = 0; z = O : u =v = w = O
(49) t = t o : u, v small
(53) 4 3 - 4t = -2Q*
(54) v*ez - *t =2 q
84 FRANCIS E. FENDELL
where
(56)
(57)
subject to
(58) ~ ( rz ,= 0, t ) + -(@ + iY), X(T, z -+ 00, t ) + 0 , ~ ( rZ,,0)= 0
If (roa- Ra)+roa, an excellent approximation,then it is convenient to define
(59) P(r, t ) E Pl(t)[l- (P/ro")]
= [Boa - RZ(t)][l - (r2/r0Z)].
Carrier (1971a) studied the special form P l ( t )= Roaexp(.t). For the more
general form (€is), by Laplace transformation (Dergarabedian and Fendell,
1972a, pp. 56-57), the relevant boundary layer divergence is
(60) w(r, z + co,t )
+2!22i)1/a][exp(st)]ds
C+im
= ( ~ ~ / ~ / r ~ ~ ) R e ( 1 / 2 xP1(s)[(s
i) - 2sZi)/(s
6 /Q](ROa
G ( v / ~ ) 1 ~ 2 ( 1 / r 0 2 ) [ (- ~ Ra)
7 ) ~ / ~-
for the R(t) of practical interest. The divergence, a function of time only, is
largest in magnitude in the steady state; if R +( R0/12)typically,
w(r, z-+ co) = -(Ro/ro)a(vC!)1~2
= 0(10-3 mph)
The net volumetric flux down into 11,and hence (in an incompressible model)
up into the core, Q(t), is given by
(611 Q = Q0[(6/7Q)a/at - 11P - (x/R0)21
where the quasi-steady discharge into the base of the core I11 is given by
boundary layer air driven radially inward by the outer inviscid flow, is now
made quantitative. It is necessary to model the radial and azimuthal velocity
components in the core; kinematic and continuity considerations suggest that,
a t least in the lower regions of 111, for this purpose it is adequate to take
(63) ru = qi = r2R/R
(64) rv = y5 = Q(RO2- R2)r2/R2
Accordingly (44) is integrated from r = 0 to r = ro a t some fixed z above the
boundary layer; the profiles for u and v are given by (63) and (64)for 0 <r < R
and by (50) and (51) for R < r 5 r , . The term uu, in (44) is a perfect differen-
tial and yields precisely zero; wu, yields zero because u is independent of z
and w is small anyway. It follows that the time-dependent, Coriolis, centri-
fugal, and pressure gradient terms yield, for p = const. and upon neglecting
terms of O(R2/rO2) relative to those of order unity,
(65) p ( r o ,z = 0 , t ) -p(r = 0, z = 0, t )
= [pQ2ROZ(Ro2 - R2)/R2]{1+[2 ln(ro/R)- 1]R2/Ro2}
+ P(d/dt)ERAln(Rb.o)I
The last term on the right-hand side is characterized by the inverse square
of the time for intensification; this time is probably much larger than the time
for equilibration of the boundary layer. Thus normally the time-derivative
term can be neglected.
However, when inertial oscillations associated with the continued radial
influx and rebound of air in I occur, a shorter time scale enters and the time
derivative term must be retained. Carrier (1971b, p. 157) suggests that the
time scale of the oscillation is 0(4R,2/l2RO2)where Rf is the final equilibrium
position of the eyewall R(t). For typical values, with R, G 250 miles, this
time scale is 20 min. I n fact, holding the convection-core pressure deficit
from the ambient fixed at about 35 mb, holding p a t its ambient sea level value,
letting R , G 250 miles and r o G 1000 miles, one finds from (65)-by dropping
the temporal derivative-that R = Rf = O(35 miles). Restoring the temporal
term, adopting as initial conditions R = O(35miles) and R s -a( RO2- R2)12R
(Carrier, 1971b, pp. 152 and 155), and holding the core pressure deficit
relative t o the ambient fixed at 35 mb (near quasi-steady conditions), one
finds from (65) that R decreases to about 16 miles in about a half-hour before
R = 0. Thus, numerical values confirm the inertial oscillation period suggested
by Carrier. Such oscillations probably reinforce the eye, rather than create it,
as noted earlier (Section 4.2). The oscillation of the eyewall is dwelled upon
because it seems to be the first proposal of a mechanism internal to the
hurricane that might explain a crudely periodic variability in intensity of 10
to 20% in peak winds, on the time scale of a few hours; such variability
appears to be observed sometimes, and attribution to changes in the ambient
86 FRANCIS 1 . FENDELL
6. CONCLUDING REMARKS
Several viewpoints not universally accepted have been adopted in this
review. The existence of, and necessity for, a greatly augmented oceanic heat
source in the inner regions of a hurricane as the basic sustaining mechanism
has been questioned. The validity of the hot-tower thesis of heating from the
tropical cumulonimbus has been scrutinized. The incomplete understanding
of the processes and time scales of tropical cyclogenesis and intensification
has been emphasized. The conviction that improved quantitative under-
standing of the tropical ambient is prerequisite t o further progress on the
deepening of tropical disturbances has been stated. Reasons for reservations
concerning the probable success of current hurricane seeding techniques have
been offered.
This unconventionality hopefully conveys two major points to the reader.
First, any serious worker in hurricanes would be very remiss not t o consult
the referenced works directly and decide for himself whether or not the
viewpoints adopted here are in fact valid. Second, this review on tropical
cyclones describes a vital subject in rapid flux to which many basic physical
and mathematical contributions are still to be made. This is not a field in
which only exquisite refinements t o elaborate computer programs remain. I n
fact, many valuable theoretical contributions in recent years have been
achieved by Carrier and Gray via an approximate solution of simplified
models with only modest computing, as opposed t o attempting direct numer-
ical simulation of the full conservation laws. The meteorologist with insight
will hopefully agree that the tropical cyclone is neither a closed subject, nor
a subject to which only those with access to very sophisticated computing
facilities can aspire to contribute.
TROPICAL CYCLONES 87
THE KINETIC
APPENDIXA. ESTIMATING ENERGY
AND WATER
CONTENTOF
HURRICANES
To estimate very quickly and roughly the total kinetic energy content of a
mature hurricane of moderate intensity, one must evaluate I where
I =-
1
2
1" pw2 d V
= 7T 1z=.?1/2
t=O
t=ro
P[~ir)J2rdr
The speed is virtually all swirl, and about half the nine mile high, axisym-
metric storm is rotating like (say) a potential vortex. The swirl is (suppose)
100 mph a t the edge of the (nonrotating) eye re = 30 miles, and the storm
extends out to ro = 500 miles. The density may be set t o a constant average
value of 5 x gm ~ m - Then
~ .
The volumetric flux down into the boundary layer is, for ro29 Ra,
(A.4) Q0= m-02w(r,z -+ co,t -+00) A -TR~~(YQ)~/~
this is also the flux up into the eyewall. The mass of air per unit time is given
by pQo where p is fairly constant a t a fixed height. The water content of this
mass of air, which falls out as precipitation, is given in mass per time by
APPENDIXB. THEMOISTADIABAT
Because of the significant role it plays in understanding tropical cyclones,
a derivation of the relation describing the moist adiabatic process seems
worth including. The following is based on unpublished notes of G.F. Carrier
of Harvard University.
When moist air expands adiabatically,the temperature eventually decreases
to a value at which the water vapor density reaches its saturation level. For
all further decreases in temperature, condensation occurs. Here it is assumed
that the condensedwater has zero volume (a good approximation),and that the
liquid precipitates out as it is formed.
An air-vapor mixture is at temperature 117, the mass of air in volume V
being m a , and the saturated vapor mass in V being m, . The corresponding
densities are pa = (m,/V) and p, = (mv/V ) ; the pressure p = p a +pV. A
relationship between T and p (say) as T changes is obtained by studying
TROPICAL CYCLONES 89
the moist adiabatic process in several steps (Fig. 22). The mixtureis separated
into two fluids (dry air and vapor), to be later recombined; this step is taken
to require no expenditure of work.
Initially, the mass m, of vapor occupies the volume V as in the top box of
Pig. 22. That volume is decreased by a process in which dm, of the vapor is
condensed while it and the remaining vapor are a t temperature T and pres-
sure pv. Thus, the new volume (t,hatof the second box) is V[l - (dm,/m,)].
The work done by external forces during this process is ( p , V dm,/m,), and is
indicated by the arrow to the left of the boxes. The heat gained Ldm, is
shown at the right. The vapor now expands adiabatically and isentropically
+
to volume ( V d V ) as shown in box 3; the new temperature T is given by
P.1) T ' / T = { V [ l -(dm,/m,)]/(V +dV)}yv-l
= 1 - (yv - l)(dmv/mv +
+ d V / V ) ..-
In the third step, the gas in box 3 is heated to temperature ( T +dT), as
indicated in box 4. The heat that must be added during this process is
P.2) +
(mv- dmv)(c,),[dT ( r v - l)(dm,/mv dV1 W I +
= m,[(c,), dT +
R,T dVIV] RvTdm, + + * * *
-
pvV (dmJmV + dV/V)-
1 ( 1 4 ~ 1 (dmJm,
) + dVM)
m, (cy,dT*RvTdV/V)+R,T dmv
m -dm
T + dT
P, dV - B-
T (1 - (V-l)dV/V)
ma (cv dT + ROT d V M
where (c,,), is the heat capacity a t constant volume of the vapor, (c,,), the
heat capacity a t constant pressure of the vapor, R, = (c,,), - (cV),, and
y v = (c,)v/(cu)v '
The dry air, on the other hand, starts off in the bottom box of volume V
with mass ma a t temperature T . It expands isentropically to volume ( V d V ) +
so that its temperature becomes T [ l - (ya- l ) ( d V / V ) ] Henceforth
. yv =
y a = y . The dry air is then heated a t constant volume to temperature
+
(T d T ) by the addition of heat in the amount rna[(c,,),dT RaT(dVl V ) ] .+
Thus a t the end of the process, a vapor mass (mv - dm,) and a dry air mass
ma occupy a volume ( V + +
d V ) a t temperature (T dT). By definition, the
process undergone will have been the moist adiabatic one if the net heat added
+
is zero, and if the final (p, dp,) is the saturation value for the final temper-
ature (IT +dT):
(B.3) ma[(cu)adT + Ra T dV/VI+
~ , [ ( G , ) ~ ~ T + R , T ~+VR ,/ TVd]m , = -Lam,
(B.4) Pv = mv/V = Pv(T)
where p,( T ) is the function that describes saturation density.
By the equation of state for dry air,
(B.5) d V /V = -dpa/pa = d TIT -dpa/pa
But (rlp,/pv) is comprised of two contributions: that due to change of volume
and that due t o the loss of mass via condensation. Thus
pV
--
+
dp, - mv - dm, V
Pv m, V+dV
=1 - (dm,/m,) - (d V /V ) +- -
*
The air velocity is denoted u,, with utu,=qa and ut S,, = w, where the
gravitational acceleration g, = - g Si, . The water vapor velocity is (u, vt). +
The vapor quantities pv, (c,,)~,(c,),., Rv and the air quantities pa, (c~),,
( c ~ ) , ,Ra have the same designations as above. The specific internal energy
of the air is e, ,and of the vapor ev . The specific heat of the liquid water sub-
stance is c l . The heat lost by radiation and all other processes is &, with units
(massllength-time3).The conservation of energy for current purposes may be
written (upon neglect of the kinetic energy contribution relative to internal
energy contributions)
(B.9) baea + ~ v e v l t, +[Paee,ui + p v e v ( ~ i+vi)l.<
= -(pa + + +
p v ) P ( u i j ~ t ) , j (kT,t),t-ctTw -Q
where ui, is the total stress tensor, k is the thermal conductivity, and
(B.lO) Pv.t + +
pv@* vt).t= --w
In general, w (the mass of water vapor condensed per unit time) must be
specified explicitly or through a prescribed mechanism; when the fluid is
saturated and (dT/dt) <0, w is known.
For steady flow with densities, pressures, and temperature dependent on the
vertical coordinate z only, with negligible diffusion so v, = 0 and utf= -par,,
in the hydrostatic approximation p s +
pg = 0, it follows from continuity that
(B.ll) (PaW),z=O, (pvw),z=--w
hence,
(B.12) + + +
pa Wea, 2 pvwev, 2 - wev PW. z ct T o = 0
With the aid of the continuity equations and the equations of state,
(B.13) +
~ a ~ [ ( ~ p ) a2T l .~vw[(cp)vTl,z - WP, z = w(ev + Rv T - CIT )
Since
(B.14) ev = cl T + L(T) - Rv T
and
(B.15) = -wpa(pv/pa). 2 = -(1/V d(pv v)
upon substitution and cancellation of the common factor w, one recovers
(B.7).
ACKNOWLEDQMEJYTS
The author is very deeply indebted to Prof. George F. Carrier of Harvard University
for generous and indispensable guidance and assistance on every aspect of the work
described here. He also wishes to thank Dr. Paul Dergarabedian of The Aerospace Corpor-
ation for many stimulating discussions. However, full responsibility for all errors lies en-
tirely with the author. All computationswere programmed by Mr. Phillip s. Feldman, of
TRW Systems. This study was initiated owing to the interest of Capt. Hugh Albers of
92 FRANCIS E. FENDELL
LISTOF SYMBOLS
PARTIAL
c1 Heat capacity of liquid watec W Azimuthal velocity component of q1
cp Heat capacity at constant pressure Wi Velocity vector for water vapor
cV Heat capacity at constant volume relative to dry air; velocity vector
e Internal energy for a fluid in a noninertial system
E Ekman number, v / Y o V Azimuthal velocity component of q1
g Magnitude of gravitational accelera- in the inviscid flow exterior to the
tion, IS11 frictional boundary layer; volume
g1 Acceleration of gravity W Vertical velocity component of pI
+
H Total static enthalpy, c,T gz+ LY W Vertical velocity component of qr in
+
H , Total stagnation enthalpy, H q2/2 the inviscid flow exterior to the
L Specific latent heat of phase transition frictional boundary layer
mr Molecular weight of species i X fir2/y$,;a factor in the moist adiabat
n Power of algebraic decay of swirl with based on d H = 0
radial distance Y Water vapor mass fraction, pV/p
p Pressure z Altitude above sea level
P Saturation vapor pressure
q Wind speed, lqtl
pi Velocity vector for a fluid in non- Greek Symbob
inertial frame rotating with earth y C&"
Q Net volumetric flux per time; heat p Density
loss per voume-time 4 ru [sometimes, r ( u - U);sometimes,
Q o Steady-state net volumetric flux per nondimensional]
time @ Tu
r Radial coordinate in cylindrical polar h
t,
rw [sometimes, T(V -'v);sometimeq
coordinates nondimensional]
R Radial position of maximum azimuth- Y rV
al velocity w Ratio of molecular weight of water
R6 Gas constant for species i , R/m, vapor to dry air
R Universal gas constant ul, Total stress tensor
RH Relative humidity y Kinematic viscosity (usually given
t Time turbulent transfer values)
’2 Temperature w Mass of water vapor condensed per
u Radial velocity component of 9, volume-time
ut Velocity vector for dry air Coriolis parameter (component of the
U Radial velocity component of pt in the angular velocity of the earth perpen-
inviscid flow exterior to the dicular to a plane locally tangential
frictional boundary layer to the sea surface in the tropics)
TROPICAL CYCLONES 93
REFERENCES*
Agee, E. M. (1972). Note on ITCZ wave disturbances and formation of Tropical Storm
Anna. Mon. Weather Rev. 100, 733-737.
Alaka, M. A. (1968). “Climatology of Atlantic Tropical Storms and Hurricanes,” ESSA
Tech. Rep. WB-6. US Govt. Printing OEce, Washington, D.C.
Anderson, L. G., and Burnham, J. M. (1973). Application of economic analyses t o hur-
ricane warnings t o residential and retail activities in the U.S. Gulf of Mexico coastal
region. Mon. Weather Rev. 101, 126-131.
Anonymous (1972). Hurricane Agnes: The most costly storm. Wealherwise 25, 174-184.
Anonymous. (1973). U.S. hurricane control test program cut. 5 0 s AngeZes Times 92, 4
February, Part 8, p. 6.
Anthes, R. A. (1971). Iterative solutions t o the steady-state axisymmetric boundary-
layer equations under an intense pressure gradient. Mon. Weather Rev. 100, 261-268.
Anthes, R. A. (1972). Development of asymmetries in a three-dimensional numerical
model of a typical cyclone. Mon. Weather Rev. 100, 461-476.
Anthes, R. A., and Johnson, D. R. (1968). Generation of available potential energy in
Hurricane Hilda (1964). Mon. Weather Rev. 96, 291-302.
Anthes, R. A., Rosenthal, S. L., and Trout, J. W. (1971). Preliminary results from a n
asymmetric model of the tropical cyclone. Mon. Weather Rev. 99, 744-758.
Arakawa, H. (1954). On the pyramidal, mountainous, and confused sea in the right or
dangerous semi-circle of typhoons. Pap. MeteoroZ. Qeophys. 5, 114-123.
Aspliden, C. I. (1971). “ On Energy Distribution in the Tropical Troposphere,” Rep.,
Dept. Meteorol., Florida State University, Tallahassce.
Atkinson, G. D. (1971). “Forecasters Guide to Tropical Meteorology,” Tech. Rep. No.
240. USAF Air Weather Serv., Scott AFB, Illinois.
Bates, J. R. (1970). Dynamics of disturbances on the Intertropical Convergence Zone.
Quart. J . Roy. Metecrrol. Soc. 96, 677-701.
Bates, J. R. (1972). Tropical disturbances and the general circulation. Quart. J . Roy.
Meteorol. SOC.98, 1-16.
Battan, L. J. (1961). T h e Nature of Violent Storms.” Doubleday, Garden City, New
York.
Battan, L. J. (1969). “Harvesting the Clouds-Advances in Weather Modification.”
Doubleday, Garden City, New York.
Black, P. G., and Anthes, R. A. (1971). On the asymmetric structure of the tropical
cyclone outflow layer. J . Atmos. Sci. 28, 1348-1366.
Black, P. G., and Mallingcr, W. D. (1972). “The Mutual Interaction of Hurricane Ginger
and the Upper-Mixed Layer of the Ocean,” Appendix D, Project Stormfury Annual
Report 1971. Nat. Hurricane Res. Lab., Coral Gables, Florida.
Black, P. G., Senn, H. V., and Courtright, C. L. (1972). Airbourne radar observations of
eye configuration changes, bright band distribution, and precipitation tilt during
the 1969 multiple seeding experiments in Hurricane Debbie. Mon. Weather Rev.
100,208-217.
Boyd, D. W., Howard, R. A., Matheson, J. E., and North, D. W. (1971). “Decision
Analysis of Hurricane Modification,” Proj. 8503 Final Rept. Stanford Res. Inst.,
Menlo Park, California.
Bradbury, D. L. (1971). “The Filling Over Land of Hurricane Camille, August 17-18,
1969,” Satellite and Mesometeorol. Res. Proj. Res. Pap. 96. Dept. Geophys. Sci.,
University of Chicago, Chicago, Illinois.
Brand, S. (1970a). “ Geographic and Monthly Variation of Very Large and Very Small
Typhoons of the Western North Pacific Ocean,” Tech. Pap. No. 13-70. Nav. Weather
Res. Facility, Norfolk, Virginia.
Brand, S. (1970b). Interaction of binary tropical cyclones of the western North Pacific.
J. Appl. Meteorol. 9, 433-441.
Brand, S. (1971). The effects on a tropical cyclone of cooler surface waters due t o upwelling
and mixing produced by a prior tropical cyclone, J. Appl. Metwrol. 10, 866-874.
Brand, S., and Bellock, J. W. (1972). “Changes in the Characteristics of Typhoons
Crossing the Philippines ” Teoh. Pap. No. 6-72. Environ. Prediction Res. Facility,
Nav. Postgrad. School, Monterey, California.
Burggraf, 0. R., Stewartson, K., and Belcher, R. (1971). Boundary layer induced by a
potential vortex. Phys. Fluid8 14, 1821-1833.
Burroughs, L. D., and Brand, S. (1973). Speed of tropical storms and typhoons after
recurvature in the western North Pacific Ocean. J. Appl. Meteorol. 12, 452-458.
Byers, H. R. (1944). “General Meteorology,” 2nd ed. McGraw-Hill, New York.
Carlson, T. N. (1969). Some remarks on African disturbances and their progress over the
tropical Atlantic. Mm. Weather Rev. 97, 716-726.
Carpenter, T. H., Holle, R. L., and Fernandez-Partaggas, J. J. (1972). Observed relation-
ships between lunar tidal cycles and formation of hurricanes and tropical storms.
Mon. Weather Rev. 100, 451-460.
Carrier, G. F. (1970). Singular perturbation theory and geophysics. S I A M (Soc. Ind.
App .Math.) Rev. 12, 175-193.
Carrier, G. F. (1971a). Swirling flow boundary layers. J. Fluid Mech. 49, 133-144.
Carrier, G. F. (1971b). The intensification of hurricanes. J. Fluid Mech. 49, 145-158.
Carrier, G. F., Hamrnond, A. L., and George, 0. D. (1971). A model of the mature hurri-
cane. J . Fluid Mech. 47, 145-170.
Charney, J. (1971). Tropical cyclogenesis and the formation of the Intertropical Con-
vergence Zone. I n ‘‘ Mathematical Problems in the Geophysical Sciences. I. Geo-
physical FIuid Dynamics (Lectures in Applied Mathematice, Vol. 13)” (W. H. Reid,
sd.), Vol. 1, pp. 336-368. Amer. Math. SOC.,Providence, Rhode Island
Charney, J. G., and Eliassen, A. (1964). On the growth of the hurricane depression.
J . AtWaO3. SCi. 21, 68-75.
Cox, J. L., and Jager, G. (1969). “A Satellite Analysis of Twin Tropical Cyclones in the
Western Pacific,” Tech. Memo. WBTMSOS 5. ESSA Space Operations Support Div.,
Silver Spring, Maryland.
Day, J. A. (1966). “The Science of Weather.” Addison-Wesley, Reading, Massachusetts.
DeAngelis, R. M. (1969). Enter Camille. Weatherwdse 22, 173-179.
Denny, W. J. (1972). Eastern Pacific hurricane season of 1971. Mon. Weather Rev. 100,
276-293.
Deppermann, C. E. (1937). “Wind and Rainfall in Selected Philippine Typhoons.”
TROPIUAL CYCLONES 95
Jordan, C. L. (1957). “A Mean Atmosl,here for the West Indies Area,” Nat. Hurricane
Res. Proj. Rep. No. 6. US. Dept. of Commerce, Washington, D.C.
Keenau, J. H., and Kcyes, F. G. (1936). “Thermodynamic Properties of Steam Including
Data for Liquid and Solid Phases.” \Viley, New York.
Kraus, E. B. (1972). “Atmosphere-Ocean Tnteraction.” Oxford Univ. Press (Clarendon),
London and New York.
Kuettner, J. P. (1971). Cloud bands in the earth’s atmosphere. Observations and theory.
Tellus 23, 404-426.
Kurihara, Y. (1971). An eleven-layer, asisymmetric, primitive equation model of a
tropical cyclone. Bull. Amer. Meteorol. Soc. 52, 769.
Leipper, D. F. (1967). Observed ocean conditions and Hurricane Hilda, 1964. J . Almos.
Sci. 24, 182-196.
Leipper, D. F., and Volgenau, D. (1972). Hurricane heat potcntial of the Gulf of Mexico.
J . Plbys. Oceanogr. 2, 2 18-224.
Lieb, H . S. (1972). Project Stormfury Director Reveals Results of Hurricane Ginger
Seeding Experiments,” News Release NOAA 72-4. U.S. Dept. of Commerce,
Washington, D.C.
Lopez, R. E. (1972a). Cuinulus Convection and Larger-scale Circulations. Part 1. A
Parametric Model of Cumulus Convection,” Pap, KO. 188. Dept. Atmos. Sci.,
Colorado State University, Fort Collins.
Lopez, R. E. (197213). “ Cumulus Convection and Larger-scale Circulations. Part 2.
Cumulus and Meso-scale Circulations,” Pap. 189. Colorado State Univ. Fort Collins.
Lorenz, E. N. (1966). The circulation of the atmosphere. Amer. Sci. 54, 402-420.
Lorenz, E. N. (1967). ‘i The Nature and Theory of the General Circulation of the Atmo-
sphere.” World Meteorol. Organ., Geneva.
Mc\Villiams, J. C. (1971). The boundary layer dynamics of symmetric vortices. Ph.D.
Thesis, Harvard University, Camhridge, Massachusetts.
Ma,hrt, L. J. (1972a). A numerical study of the influence of advective accelerations in an
icicalizetl, low-latitude, planetary boundary layer. J . Atmos. Sci. 29, 1477-1484.
Rlahrt, L. J . (197213). A numerical study of coupling between the boundary layer and
free atmosphere in an accelerated low-latitude flow. J . Ataaos. Sci. 29, 1485-1495.
Malkus, J. S. (1958). On the structure ant1 maintenance of the mature hurricane eye.
J . Meteorol. 15,337-349.
Malkus, J. S. (1960). Recent developrnonts in studies of penetrative convection and an
applicatiori to hurricane cumnlonimhun tuuvrs. I n ‘‘ Cumulus Dynamics ” (C. E.
Anderson, ed.), pp. 66-84. l’ergamori, Osforcl.
nlalkus, J. S. (1962). Largc-scale interactions. In “ T h e Sea” (M. N. Hill, ed.), Vol. 1,
pp. 88-294. Wiley (Intersciencc), New York.
Blalkus,J . S.,and Riehl, H. (1960). On the dynamics and energy transformation in steedy-
stat.e hurricanes. Tellus 12, 1-20.
Rlalkus, J. S., Ronne, C., and Chafee, 11. (1961). Cloud patterns in Hurricane Daisy, 1968.
Tellzts 13, 8-30.
Mallinger, W. D. (1971). “Project Stormfury Experimental Eligibility in the Western
North Pacific,” Appendis I,, Project Stormfury Annual Report 1970. Nat. Hurricane
Rex. Lab., Coral Gablos, Florida.
Malone, M. J. and Leimer, D. R. (1971).“Estimation of the Economic Benefits to DOD
from Improved Tropical Cyclonr Forecart.ing,” Rep. Headquarters Military
Airlift Command, Scott AFB, Illinois.
Manabe, S., Holloway, J . L., Jr., and Stone, H. &I. (1970). Tropical circulation in a time-
integration of a global model of t h r atmosphere. J . Atmos. Sci. 27, 580-613.
Matano, H., and Sekioka, 31. (1971). Some aspectn of extratropical transformation of a
tropical cyclone. J . Meteorol. Soc. J a p . 49, 736-743.
98 FRANCIS 1. FENDELL
Revesz, W., Jr. (1971). Comparison of effects of various tropical storms on the vertical
temperature of the ocean using pictorial representation. Master’s Thesis, Naval
Postgraduate School, Monterey, California.
Riehl, H. (1954). “Tropical Meteorology.” McGraw-Hill, New York.
Riehl, H. (1963a). Some relations between wind and thermal structure of steady state
hurricanes. J. Atmos. Sci. 20, 276-287.
Riehl, H. (1963b). On the origin and possible modification of hurricanes. Science 141,
1001-1010.
Riehl, H. (1969a). On the role of the tropics in the general circulation of the atmo-
sphere. Weather 24, 288-303.
Riehl, H. (1969b). Some aspects of cumulonimbus convection in relation to tropical
weather disturbances. Bull. Amer. Meteorol. SOC.50, 587-595.
Riehl, H. (1972a). “Introduction t o the Atmosphere,” 2nd ed. McGraw-Hill, New York.
Riehl, H. (1972b). Intensity of recurved typhoons. J. AppZ. Meteorol. 11, 613-615.
Riehl, H., and Malkus, J. (1961). Some aspects of Hurricane Daisy, 1958. Tellw 13,
181-213.
Rosenthal, S. L. (1970). A circularly symmetric primitive equation model of tropical
cyclone development containing an explicit water vapor cycle. Mon. Weather Rev.
98,643-663.
Rosenthal, S. L. (1971a). A circularly symmetric primitive equation model of tropical
cyclones and its reponse to artificial enhancement of the convective heating func-
tions. Man. Weather Rev. 99, 414-426.
Rosenthal, S. L. (1971b). The response of a tropical cyclone model t o vsriations in
boundary layer parameters, initial conditions, lateral boundary conditions, and
domain size. Mon. Weather Rev. 99, 767-777.
Rosenthal, S. L. (1971~).“Hurricane Modeling at the National Hurricane Research
Laboratory (1970),” Appendix C, Project Stormfury Annual Report 1970. Nat.
Hurricane Res. Lab., Coral Gables, Florida.
Saffir, H. S. (1973). Hurricane wind and storm surge. Mil. Eng. 65, 4-5.
Sanders, F., and Burpee, R. W. (1968). Experiments in barotropic hurricane track
forecasting. J . AppZ. Meteorol. 7 , 313-323.
Schwarz, K. (1970). The unprecedented rains in Virginia associated with the remnants
of Hurricane Camille. Man. Wedher Rev. 98, 851-859.
Shea, D. J. (1972). ‘‘ The Structure and Dynamics of the Hurricane’s Inner Core Region,”
Pap. No. 182. Dept. Atmos. Sci., Colorado State university, Fort Collins.
Sheets, R. C. (1972). “Some Statistical Characteristics of the Hurricane Eye and Mini-
mum Sea-level Pressure,” Appendix I, Project Stormfury Annual Report 1971.
Nat. Hurricane Ree. Lab., Coral Gables, Florida.
Shuleykin, V. V. (1970). The power of a tropical hurricane as a function of the underlying
sea surface temperature. Izv., Acad. Sci., USSR, Atmos. Oceanic Phya. 6,729-739.
Shuleykin, V. V. (1972). Development and decay of a tropical hurricane under various
thermal conditions. fzv., Acud. Sci., USSR, Atmos. Oceanic Phys. 8, 1-17.
Simpson, R. H. (1971). “The Decision Process in Hurricane Forecasting,” NOAA Tech.
Memo. NWS SR-53. Nat. Weather Sew. Southern Region Headquarters, Fort Worth,
Texas.
Simpson, R. H., and Frank, J. R. (1972). Atlantic hurricane season of 1971. M a n .
Weather Rev. 100, 256-267.
Simpson, R. H., and Malkus, J. S. (1964). Experiments in hurricane modification.
Sei. Amer. 211, 27-37.
Simpson, R. H., and Pelisser, J. M. (1971). Atlantic hurricane season of 1970. Man.
Weather Rev. 99, 269-277.
Spark, E. H. (1971). The willy-willy. Bull. Amer. Meteorol. SOC.52, 574-575.
100 FRANCIS E. FENDELL
Note Added in Proof. Several recent measurements in hurricanes seem to cast doubt on
the Riehl-Malkus oceanic heat source postulate. First, properly adjusted measurements
i n the frictional boundary layer of Hurricane Ginger (September, 1971), a minimal
hurricane in which winds did not much exceed 90 mph, indicate that at the height of
500 f t above sea level the static temperature decreased 1"-1.6"C from edge t o eyewall.
The need for oceanic heat transfer to maintain a supposedly isothermal boundary layer
appears nonexistent, if this measurement proved t.ypical. Also, both radar measurements
and satellite photography of the eyewalls of Eastern Pacific Hurricane Irah on 23 Sept-
ember 1973 (with maximum wind speed of 130 kt) and of North Atlantic Hurricane
Ellen on 21 September 1973 (with maximum wind speed of 120 k t andminimum central
pressure of 962 mb) indicated significant outward sloping of the eyewall [see, e.g.,
NASA Johnson Space Center Skylab Program photograph SL3-118-2189]. In fact, radar
suggests that the eyewall of the moderately intense cyclone Ellen sloped outward at 46"
above 15,000 ft; past dismissal of radar data reporting significant outward eyewall
sloping may have been unjustified. As a hurricane matures, the data suggest the intense
convective updrafts in the core tilt more from the vertical (perhaps permitting pmipi-
tation, re-evaporated during descent, t o enrich the low-level inflow), and persist longer
(50 min, as opposed to 10-min lifespan further from the core) [Black, P. C. (1974).
Preliminary assessment of handheld photographic observation of tropical storms from
space. In "Skylab Visual Observations," Chap. 16. NASA Johnson Space Center,
Houston, Texas]. The fact that compressional heating in the eye can directly contribute
to the lightening of a column of air whose base lies in the highly swirling eyewall, obviates
the need for an oceanic heat source to achieve that pressure deficit from ambient oom-
patible with observed hurricane wind speeds. On the other hand, if the low-level inflow
layer were to prove saturated near the eyewall, augmentation within the hurricane of
ambient-level heat transfer from the ocean to the atmosphere would still be required.
A NUMERICAL STUDY OF VACILLATION
A. Quinet
lnstitut Royal MCtCorologique de Belgique, Bruxelles, Belgium
. . . . . . . . . . . 141
4.5. Comments on the Various Physical PI,
5. The Numerical Study of Vacillation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 149
1. TNTRODUCTION
It is common knowledge that the motion of the atmosphere is extremely
complex. However, the upper level \reather maps exhibit flow patterns with
more or less permanent and characteristic properties. Perhaps the most
surprising observation is the extremely restricted number of scales of motion
as compared with the a priori infinite number of degrees of freedom involved
in the general thermohydrodynamical equations. The existence of moving
waves whose progression is associated with a change in the tilt of their
through and ridge lines, as well as the alternation between quasi-zonal
and essentially meridional (lobed) circulations, are also typical features of
the large-scale atmospheric flow.
101
102 A. QUMET
2. THELABORATORY
SIMULATION
OF LARGE-SCALE FLOW
ATMOSPHERIC
spheric flow. There have been many attempts in this direction in the past
(for a n historical review, see Fultz et al., 1959).
Almost twenty-five years ago, such experiments, first suggested by
Rossby (1947) and Starr were carried out by D. Fultz a t the University of
Chicago. I n his initial experiments, Fultz (1949) generated thermally driven
circulation in a rotating hemispherical shell of liquid. For suitable conditions
of rotation rate and thermal forcing, he observed flow patterns for which the
speeds of flow and changes with latitude compare reasonably well with the
wind speeds observed in the atmosphere, provided the speeds are expressed
in an appropriate unit, i.e. the equatorial rim speed.
This quantitative agreement stimulated further work in the laboratory
modeling of the atmosphere. It should be recalled that, in analogy with the
earth, where the resultant gravity field is nearly normal to the earth's mean
sea level surface, Rossby (1926) suggested using as a bottom surface for the
tank the paraboloid whose shape is the equipotential surface of the resultant
of the local gravity field and of the centrifugal force due to the rotation of
the vessel. For the rotation rate imposed in laboratory arrangements to
simulate the atmospheric conditions, the slope of this equipotential surface
is extremely small.
If one now considers a nearly radial gravity field operating on a fluid in
motion on a sphere, i t is clear that this configuration of the force field is
impossible to reproduce with laboratory devices. It should however be noted
that the effect of the curvature of the earth can be taken into account by
other factors. For instance, in the case of a barotropic flow in arotatingtank,
the theorem of conservation of absolute vorticity shows that an inward
radial depth decrease of the fluid is dynamically analogous t o an inward
radial increase of entrainment vorticity (usually denoted by f in meteorology).
It should be noted that the use of a bottom surface normal to the resultant
force field operating on the fluid in the tank suppresses the radial depth
gradient. On the other hand, the radial increase of depth in an hemispherical
shell operates in an opposite direction t o the one imposed to simulate the
poleward increase of the earth's vorticity in barotropic flows.
This is perhaps one of the reasons why Fultz quickly dispensed with the
hemispherical arrangement and used a cylindrical vessel, the so-called dish-
pan, which is, for a given experiment, rotating a t constant angular velocity Sl
(simulating the west to east rotation of the earth) around the vertically
oriented axis of the cylinder. Differential heating is provided, a t the bottom
disk, by steady symmetrically distributed heating a t the periphery (simulating
equatorial conditions) and cooling a t the center of the disk (simulating polar
conditions).
Experiments with a cylindrical annulus rotating around its vertical axis
were initiated in 1950 by R. Hide a t Cambridge University. I n these experi-
104 A. QUINET
ments, the heat source is at the outside wall which is a t constant temperature
T, (simulating low latitude heating) and the cold source is a t the inside
wall a t constant temperature T, (simulating high latitude cooling, T,< Tb).
When experiments are performed a t different rotation rates and different
intensities of the thermal forcing (i.e. for different south-north temperature
contrasts) different types of flow patterns are generated. Roughly speaking,
the dishpan experiments and those with a cylindrical annulus give the same
qualitative observations. However, the reproducibility of the results is
much better in the annulus experiments, presumably because the flow is
much more constrained by the geometry of the system and consequently
less sensitive to random perturbation in the initial conditions of operation.
For some intensities of thermal forcing and some rotation rates, the flow
is symmetric with respect to the rotation axis and proceeds as in a trade wind
cell, with upward motion at the warm rim and downward motion a t the cold
source. While moving northward in the upper layer (from the heat source
t o the cold source) the fluid is deflected by the rotation so that southerly
winds are gradually changed into winds with a westerly component. At the
“ pole,” the fluid particles subside and give rise, when moving to the south
(from the cold source to the warm source), to northeasterly trade winds in
the bottom layer. From these observations presenting obvious similarities
with what is known about the tropical atmosphere, Fultz et al. (1959) have
called this flow a Hadley flow.
For other operating conditions, unsymmetric flows with traveling waves
arise. Some of these have a striking resemblance t o the Rossby waves which
are observed on upper level synoptic maps a t middle and high latitudes.
This similarity has led to the term: Rossbypows.
Careful experiments have shown that it was possible to distinguish several
types of Rossby flows, each of them constituting a Rossby regime. Thus, Hide
(1968) was the first (1950) to observe a steady Rossby regime in which the
waves progress a t constant speed and without changing their shape. The ex-
istence of another Rossby regime was also discovered by Hide (1953, 1958),
namely a periodic regime in which the Rossby waves undergo periodic changes
in their amplitude, shape, and progression (wave speed). Hide called this
phenomenon vacillation. Finally, nonperiodic flows have also been observed,
first (1950) by Long and Owens working with the dishpan arrangement at
Chicago (Fultz et al., 1964) and are classified into the irregular Rossby regime.
To sum up, the Hadley 00w involves a single type ofregime, called the Hadley
regime, while Rossby flows can fall into one of the three types: steady,
vacillating, or irregular Rossby regimes.
The critical conditions of thermal forcing and rotation rate for the transi-
tion between the Hadley and the steady Rossby regimes as well as between
steady Rossby regimes with different wavenumbers have been experimentally
A NUMERICAL STUDY OF VACILLATION 105
The sudden transition from the Hadley to the Rossby regime when the
rotation rate is progressively increased suggests the intervention of some
mechanism of dynamic instability. According t o Bolin (1952) and following
the theory of baroclinic (Charney, 1947; Eady, 1949) and barotropic (Kuo,
1949) instability, the dynamic instability condition would result from the
increase of the wind shear (both horizontal and vertical) that might be
associated with the increase of the rotation rate. But the observed restabiliza-
tion of the symmetric Hadley regime at high thermal forcing (upper part of
Fig. 1) then appears as paradoxical. Indeed, it can be expected that intense
thermal forcing generates high horizontal temperature gradients within the
fluid and consequently, according to the thermal wind relation, high vertical
wind shear. The paradox was solved by Lorenz (1962) who pointed out that
intense thermal forcing gives rise to intense upward motions of warm air
near the outer rim and downward motion of cold air near the center (or the
inner rim). Consequently, the static stability of the fluid increases with the
thermal forcing so that finally the flow becomes baroclinically stable again
and the symmetric Hadley regime is reestablished. I n this context it has to
be emphasized that baroclinic instability is considered as the single mechanism
responsible for the transition from the Hadley to the steady Rossby regime.
This has been indirectly confirmed by Lorenz (1962) who generated steady
Rossby regimes in a model in which the process of barotropic instability was
suppressed.
Let us also point out that, if vertical motion plays an essential role in
realizing the critical conditions of static stability allowing the reappearance
of Hadley flows, some differences can be anticipated according to the way
in which the increase of static stability can be accomplished. I n the Hadley
regime, the cellular structure of the flow ensures a self-stabilization. This is
not the case in Rossby flows where the motion is essentially quasi-horizontal.
Accordingly, the reestablishment of a Hadley regime from a Rossby regime
will presumably need a higher thermal forcing than the one compatible with
a directly established Hadley flow. This hysteresis in the observation of
Hadley flows according to the sequence of generated flows has indeed been
observed by Fultz et al. (1959) and has been explained by Lorenz (1962).
The laboratory simulation of both Hadley and Rossby flows strongly
suggests that, in spite of the obvious geometrical distortion, laboratory
experiments are able t o capture some of the very essential properties of the
large-scale atmospheric motions. Interest will be more particularly focused
here on Rossby vacillating flows which appear sufficiently simple as to
remain " understandable " and, consequently, capable of improving our
knowledge of the large-scale atmospheric motions. Indeed, the distinction
between vacillation and nonperiodic flows seems to be more a question of
degree than one of fundamental character, as already denoted by the fact
108 A . QUWET
that they both belong to the same class of flow. The observation of several
sequences of upper air synoptic maps suggests that the evolution of the
atmospheric 00w pattern could be interpreted as some " perturbation " of a
vacillation cycle. If this could actually be confirmed by a detailed analysis,
much would be gained about the understanding of the behavior of the
atmosphere.
FIQ.3. Trace obtained by Fultz el al. (1959) of the temperature difference between
inlet and outlet water a t the cold source during vacillation. The period of the cycle is
about 12 revolutions.
110 A. QUINET
N v’u‘l
r=O.B rb
-2,
-2 I
(a1 (b) ( C )
Fig. 2 lies in the fact that the trough and ridge lines no longer exhibit fluctua-
tions in orientation during the cycle but that the wave amplitude undergoes
major oscillations. The wave may even nearly vanish during the cycle so
that the flow appears then as quasi-zonal (Figs. 5a and 5c). Therefore, these
authors have proposed calling this type of vacillation “ amplitude vacillation.”
As a matter of fact, amplitude vacillation is most common with high viscous
fluids and appears at a lower rotation rate and higher thermal forcing than
the tilted trough vacillation (Fowlis and Hide, 1965).
112 A. QUINET
3. A MODELATMOSPHERE
FOR THE STUDYOF VACILLATION
where va is the velocity of P with respect to the coordinate system (x’, x2,x 3 ) ,
(3.2) v a = dX,(t)/&t = 2,
while ra is the velocity of R with respect to this coordinate system. Obviously,
the velocity of all the fluid particles form a velocity field
(3.3) 7"= V,(d, 5 2 , 23, t )
the unit length being chosen. The components V , and V" are respectively
the covariant and contravariant components of the vector V and are associ-
ated by the metric tensor according to
(3.6) V a = gad Va
a property which has already been used in (3.4).The covariant components
V a , v, , r, associated respectively with the contravariant components V", va,
r a are such that
(3.1') V,=V,-Tr,
For the sake of completeness, let us also recall that the so-called "physical
components " of V are given by
along the ascending vertical (2' = a, x2 = h ) of each mean bea level point
(a, b ) . These approximat<ionsare acceptable for the description of the large-
scale flow of a shallow atmosphere in quasi-static motion. From a geometrical
point of view, the splitting between horizontal and vertical coordinates in
(3.15) implies that the three-dimensional space (x', x 2 , p ) is layered into
isobaric sheets by the pressure parametcr p .
Let us immediately note that, according to (3.15),
(3.17) g31= gr3= 0 for i = 1, 2 and g33= (pg)-2
(3.18) Q=g33y
where y is the determinant I g,, I so that
g3' = g i 3 =0 for i = 1, 2 and g33= l/g33
(3.19)
gl1= g22/y, gZ2= S l h , g12 = g2I = -912ly
and
(3.20) g t k p= a,', k = 1, 2
Finally, the velocity of the carth (R) with respect to the coordinate system
(xl, x2, p ) is given by
(3.21) yl = r2 0
the coordinates xl, x2 being imbedded in R, while
(3.22) r3 = apiat
(xl, x2, z being kept constant) so that
(3.23) V 1 = 211, 8 2 = 112, v3 =w - y3
so that
Equation (3.28) can also be put in the more convenient form (Van Isacker,
1963; Phillips, 1965)
(3.29') aV/at + V(*V6 V B )-V x curl(V + E) = -V+ -p-lVp
r
free of symbols and where x is the vector product and V the usual " del "
operator.
When (3.15) is taken into account, the equation of the horizontal motion
deduced from (3.28) can be written
(3.30) d ' l / ' , / d t - - V ' ~ k a , g , ~ - S V 3 v 3 a , q ~ ~v+3 a , r 3 t 2 w i , v a = -az+
for i = 1, 2.
The third equation of (3.28) is always replaced, in the study of large-scale
atmospheric flow, by the hydrostatic approximation
(3.31) a=+= -,,-I
for studying the atmosphere has been discussed by Lorenz (1960), Van
Isacker (1963), and Phillips (1965). As the diagnostic equation (3.31) replaces
the equation of motion along the vertical, a consistent approximate kinetic
energy is defined as the kinetic energy of the horizontal motion only. I n this
case, the theorem of the (approximate) kinetic energy holds provided (3.30)
reduces to
(3.32) d V , / d t - - 3 V j V ' " a , g l ' " + 2 W , ~ ~ 3-a,4
=
Note that the terms which have been suppressed in (3.30) may be considered
as negligibly small from scale analysis considerations.
I n analogy with (3.29'), (3.32) can also be put in the form
(3.33) av,/at + a , w j 7') - etj vx +f) + a3 v,= -a, 4
where 5 is the " vertical " component of the relative vorticity
(3.34) 5 =el' a, V j = ( 1 / d P ) ( a l ~-
, a, v,)
and f the vertical component of the vorticity of the earth's rotation
(3.35) f = 2%12/3/
called the Coriolis parameter. The erjand e,, tensors are defined by
ell = eZ2 = e l l = e22 = 0
-
(3.36) el, = - eZ1= 47; el2 = -e21= 1/47
and satisfy the relation
(3.37) etfg,, ekl= -9"
With (3.15) the continuity equation (Defrise, 1964) assumes the form
where the first term on the left-hand side is the isobaric divergence of the
velocity field ( V1,V 2 ) ,
(3.39) 8 f Wd;)add; V , )
Finally, the thermodynamic equation assumes the form
(3.40) c,, dTldt - p - l dpldt = H
where T is the absolute temperature, cp the specific heat of the fluid at
constant pressure, and H the rate of heating per unit mass.
With the ideal gas state equation
(3.41) P = pRT,
120 A. QULNET
where R is the specific gas constant for dry air, Eqs. (3.31))(3.33),(3.38),and
(3.40)form a closed differential set in the six unknown functions V1,V2,W,
4,
p, and T and determine, at least in principle, the evolution of a n inviseid
dry atmosphere once suitable initial and boundary conditions are prescribed.
The fluid used in laboratory experiments (generally water) can be con-
sidered as being incompressible so that p is a function of T only and is
expressed by the thermal expansion law
(3.41’) p =POP - E(T - To)]
where E is the coefficient of thermal expansion of the liquid and po its density
at temperature T o .Consequently, except for using (3.41’)instead of (3.41),
the large-scale atmospheric flow and the geophysical laboratory flows are
governed by analogous sets of equations. I n the remaining part of this
paper, we shall limit ourself to the atmospheric case.
(3.45) S ( A , B ) = (l/d;)
al(y1‘2gi’A8, B ) = AV2B +&(A, B )
which is also the divergence of gifAa, B in (xl,x2)-space.
Following Helmholtz’ theorem, the isobaric velocity field can be repre-
sented with the aid of two functions i+h and x,namely
(3.46)l 17 = -ei’ *
a, +9” a,x
The reversed convention regarding the sign of x is also used.
A NUMERICAL STUDY OF VACILLATION 121
(3.47)
+ is the &earn function and x the velocity potential of the isobaric wind
v = ( V l , V2).
Recalling the definitions (3.34) and (3.39) of the isobaric vorticity 5 and
divergence 6 respectively, we have
(3.48) 5 = VZ*
(3.49) 6 = VZX
so that, according to (3.46), $,I expresses the nondivergent, rotational part
of the wind and x its divergent, irrotational part.
Operating with ejt a,(...) and (y1l2)-la l ( y 1 / 2 g J-..)
i on the equations of
the horizontal motion (3.33) we obtain a prognostic equation for 5 and 6
respectively, the so-called isobaric vorticity and divergence equations.
Formally, the unknown functions V , and V 2 are now replaced by 5 and x,
a substitution which proves useful in dynamic meteorology.
At this stage, it is essential to mention two attitudes in the mathematical
modeling of the atmosphere. One is based on the empirical fact that, in a
shallow atmosphere, the large-scale wind field ie nearly determined by the
geopotential field 4. Assuming that this condition strictly holds leads to
replacing the equation of the isobaric divergence of the wind by a diagnostic
equation, the so-called balance equation, between the geopotential field 4
and the stream functionJ! , I only. From a physical point of view, the balance
equation ensures a permanent adjustment between the 4- and the #-fields
and, consequently, radically suppresses the gravity inertial waves. Such
models are usually called balanced modele. It then becomes possible to use
numerical integration time steps of the order of lo4 sec which are sufficient
to adequately describe the evolution of the remaining Rossby waves (periods
of the order of lo5 sec).
The other attitude consists of maintaining the isobaric divergence equation.
But, for the atmosphere, the integration time step is then necessarily of the
order of lo2 sec, which seems extremely painstaking as compared with the
period of the Rossby waves. However, because gravity waves are supposed
to be important in some circumstances, in particular when the air flows over
mountains, this procedure is now widely used in forecasting models which
are then referred to as primitive equation models. Finally, it should be noted
that J. Van hacker (personal communication, 1971) recently developed a
new type of atmospheric model in which the gravity inertial waves are
Btered out without imposing a strict condition of balance between the 4- and
122 A. QUINET
(3.62) 7=5+f
Writing
(3.53)
(3.54) 0 = v=x
A NUMERICAL STUDY O F VACILLATION 123
3.3.2. The Equations of the Two-Layer Model. For the numerical integration
of the system (3.511, (3.56), (3.581,the atmosphere is subdivided into isobaric
layers. Obviously, it is necessary that this partitioning not violate the law
of conservation of total energy. Here the procedure followed by Lorenz
(1960) in the case of a two-layer model is recalled. Its vertical structure is
schematically represented in Fig. 6. The three isobaric surfaces of the model
are denoted by p o , pz , and y4 ; p o refers to the surface pressure and will be
put equal to 100 cbar, p z = y0/2, while a t the uppermost level p s = 0. Each
x,
of the functions lfi, and 8 is replaced by two functions Ifig; xl, x3; I3 el,
P4=0
p = Po 0.0.9
2 2
FIG.6. Vertical cross section of the two-layer model. Functions 8 < , xl, and #, are
x,
defined at odd levels p , with i = 1, 3; their expression in terms of the variables 8, u,
#, and T are also reported.
124 A. QUINET
v2x, - VZX, = v2
iopoiz apt
x 3 ( x 1 , x2)
The finite difference form of (3.51) and (3.56) is obtained by replacing the
derivatives with respect t o p by finite differences, thus
(3.64) (W)V2$,= -4#, 9 rl,) -&f, Xj)
and
(3.65) ( W e , = -J($j, 0,) - - X ( O j , xj)
-
e,-1v2xj-1- e j + 1 v 2 x , + 1
Pj- 1 -PI + 1
for j = 1 and 3, H , being the heating rate in the layer j, while some rule is
CP
+- (A
H , Po IC
3.3.3. The Energetics of the Two-Layer Model. The aim of this sect'ion is
t>oensure the energet,ic consistcncy of the formulation of the t,wo-layermodel.
Hence, it will deal with t'he conservative, insulated model only.
In an atmosphere in strict hydrost'atic equilibrium, the gravitation potential
energy P and the internal energy 1 are proportional (Margules, 1903).
Therefore, in large-scale atmospheric energet,ics, there is no reason to deal
separately wit,li these two quantities which are always associated in the
definition of the total potential energy
(3.67)
(3.69)
where the subscript I,!I indicates that only the rotational part of the wind is
taken into account. Using (3.46),we have
(3.70)
(3.71)
zero too. Indeed, the Jacobian always involves a stream function + and,
recalling (3.46), assumes the form
(3.73) JW 8 = vlki a, t
where f is a flow variable. Such a term expresses the transport of by the
nondivergent wind and simply redistributes 5 on the given isobaric surface.
Obviously such a process cannot contribute to modify the average value
o f t on the surface.
According t o (3.67) and (3.65),the budget of P + I for an insulated model
then assumes the form
(3.74) ( a / a t ) (+
~ I ) = cpg-lp;yplx -p3x) J x2we, d x
I n the same way, by virtue of (3.72) and (3.64),
(3.75)
(3.76)
Thus, from (3.74) and (3.76), the balance equation (3.66) ensures the
conservation of the total energy of the insulated nondissipative two-layer
model. Note that this condition leaves O2 arbitrary.
Of considerable interest in atmospheric energetics also is the concept of
available potential energy, originally introduced by Margules (1903) and
which represents the (small) portion of the total potential energy capable of
being transformed into kinetic energy. Conventionally, the available potential
energy is defined as the excess of the total potential energy above its value
obtained by an adiabatic rearrangement of the mass leading t o a stably
stratified atmosphere with horizontal isobaric (or isentropic) surfaces. Van
Mieghem (1957) has shown that this reference state is the one of minimum
total potential energy. An approximate form of the available potential
energy, presenting the main advantage of being expressible only in terms of
the current state of the fluid, has been derived by Lorenz (1955).
I n the two-layer model considered, the potential temperature is defined at
a few levels only, so that a continuous redistribution of the mass cannot be
envisaged. Nevertheless, it is still possible to define a state of minimum
potential energy.
Introducing, with Lorenz (1960), the following new variables 8 and a:
(3.77) e = *(el + e3), = +(e3 - 8,)
so that 6 is the vertically averaged potential temperature and u a measure
of the static stability, the total potential energy (3.68) can be written
(3.78) P +I =c p g - l p , ,
s (ae - bu)
A NUMERICAL STUDY OF VACILLATION 127
+
with a = [(3/4)" (1/4)K]/2 and b = [(3/4)"- (1/4)n]/2. Now, Eq. (3.65)
with H , = 0 implies the conservation of the mean square potential tempera-
ture
+ +
with 8 = 0 8' and u = 0 a’, is also conserved. Accordingly, 15 has a
maximum value urn when u' = 8' = 0, i.e. when the isobaric surfaces (where
the temperature field is defined) are also isentropic. Clearly, in this case, the
total potential energy (3.78) reaches its minimum value attainable by adia-
batic process. The available potential energy in the two-layer model is then
given by
A =cp 1
g- ip0 [(ae - au) - ( a -~bum)] a = c, g-lpo b - u) a
(3.82)
Obviously, from (3.82) and (3.81), the budget of A assumes the same form
as the budget of P + I so that the adiabatic two-layer model conserves also
the sum of the (so defined) available potential energy and of the kinetic
energy. Note that this condition imposes the definition of B2 according to
(3.80).
For the sake of completeness, let us also mention that the energetic con-
sistency of less simplified models allows one t o define (Lorenz, 1960) #2 as
follows :
so that is the stream function a t the mean level p2 and T the stream function
of the vertical wind shear.
3.3.4. The Basic Physical Processes of the Model. With the new variables
$, T , 8, and u, the balance equation (3.66) assumes the form
(3.86) bc, V28 = X( f , T)
When the vorticity equations (3.64) are added for j= 1 and 3, we obtain,
taking (3.63) into account,
(3.87) (a/at)v2*= -*{J($19 71)+J(h7311 9
transport vorticity from place to place, and do not alter the horizontally
averaged values of V z $ and 8%.The actual source of vorticity in the model
is represented by the S term in (3.90),involving the divergent wind potential
X. This term is associated with the (baroclinic) conversion processes between
potential and kinetic energy [see Eq. (3.75)]. Thus, the change of shear
vorticity is made up of two contributions: (i) an initial one, represented by the
square bracket of (3.89), which locally modifies, but does not change in the
mean, the shear vorticity of the flow; and (ii) a source term, the S term in
(3.89),which represents the iilfluence of the conversions between kinetic and
potential energy and which alters, both locally and in the mean, the shear
vorticity of the flow.
With the new variables (3.77),the adiabatic form of the thermal equations
(3.65) becomes
(3.93) 0 ) - J ( 7 , u) +S(u,
aejat == A(*, x)
and
(3.94) aa/at= --J(T, 0) - J ( $ , 0) +Q(e, X )
I n both Eqs. (3 93) and (3.94)the first two terms on the right side represent
the local rate of temperature change due to heat advection by the non-
divergent wind. These terms are similar to the vorticity advection terms in
+
(3.88) and (3.90), with 0 substituted by V2$ f and u by V27. The third
terms S and Q express through the continuity equation (3.54), the adiabatic
temperature changes resulting from vertical motions.
3.3.5.1. Frictioii , It has been rccogiiizcd (Lorenz, 1962) that friction plays
an essential role in the dynamics of models intended to simulate laboratory
flows. I n order to take frictional cffccts into account, Lorenz introduces a
drag a t the surface p o proportional to the wind in the lower layer and also a
drag a t the surface p z proportional to the difference between the winds in the
upper and lower layers. If thc coefficients of proportionality, i.e. the co-
efficients of friction, are 2F and F‘ at p o and p z respectively, the additional
terms on the right side of (3.88) and (3.90)assume, respectively, the forms
(3.95) - FV2$ + FV’T
and
(3.96) FV2$ - ( F +2F’)V2-r
3.3.5.2. Heating. The parameterization of the heating will also be per-
formed following Lorenz’ procedure (1962). The heat exchange between the
130 A. QUINET
underlying surface and the lower layer is assumed proportional to the differ-
ence between the preassigned temperature of the surface O* and the temper-
ature of the lower layer. Similarly, the heat exchange between the lower and
the upper layers is taken proportional to the difference between the temper-
ature of these layers. If the heating coefficients are denoted by 2H and H'
for the lower and upper layer respectively, the additional terms on the right
side of (3.93) and (3.94) are, respectively
N 1.085, a2 = (3"
a1 = (4/3)" + 3-")/2 N 1.29,
and
lead to
(3.101) 3x < F 23 x sec-l
A NUMERICAL STUDY OF VACILLATION 131
(3.105) a, = 1, a2 = a3 = 0
will be used that still warrant that the direction of the heat transfers be
correctly represented.
4. THESPECTRAL
DYNAMICS
AND ENERGETICS
OF THE MODEL
so that
(4.3) y=l
and
(4.4) g l l = g22 = 1, g’2 == g 2 1 z0
vo.o=1
vm, = 4%
cos(rny/L)
(4.5)
vm,, = 2 sin(rny/L)cos(nx/L)
q$,,, ,,= 2 sin(rny/L)sin(nx/L)
m and n being integers (rn, n = 1, 2 , . . .). These functions are such that
jOznLd x IOnLdyF, F j = 2 2 L 2 8$
where 8,’ is the Kronecker symbol (3.11).Thus each scale of the fields of
motion is characterized by a pair of integers (rn, n), where rn refers to the
meridional wave shape or mode and n to the zonal wavenumber. The de-
composition of the fields into their spectral components not only allows a
clear and easy identification of each scale of motion but also provides the
possibility of further simplifying the model equations by discarding, in the
development of the dependent variables, all but a small number of scales.
Vacillation has been identified as consisting of a cyclic modification of a
pattern including a single longitudinal wave n. Consequently, we shall use a
set of functions F, including only one single zonal wavenumber n (n # 0).
Moreover, it was shown that the wave motion cycle is accompanied by a
concomitant variation of the zonal flow. Consequently vacillation is definitely
a nonlinear phenomenon where the interaction of the wave with the zonal
flow plays an essential role. The minimum set of basic functions t o be used
in a channel for describing this kind of interaction consists of the five func-
tions y z ,o , n , 91;. ,,, v2,
n, and I&,,, with n # 0. Obviously we also need
the function q ~ associated
~ , ~ with the horizontal mean of the dependent
variables ($, 7,8, . . .). On the other hand, the function vl, is indispensable
to model the laboratory thermal forcing condition. Thus, our ordered mini-
mum set of basic functions F , is
dependent variable considered; (ii) two zonal components, (1, 0) and (2, 0),
of the first and second mode respectively; and (iii) a wave component n of
the first two modes (1, n) and ( 2 , n ) . Then the #, T, and 8 fields assume the
forms
(4.7)
2
#(x,Y, t ) = L2f C {#m, o( t) vm. O(Y)
m= 1
+ $m, n ( t ) v m , n(x, Y) + #h, n ( t ) d n . n(5, Y))
(4-8)
(4.7')
i= 1
for eastward moving waves, the wave (2, n ) lags behind the wave (1, n ) if
pa. - pl,, > rr so that sin(p2, - p l , ) < 0 or, equivalently, if Cl, ,,Cb. ,
- Ci, ,,C2, is negative.
i 2.0 i ii , n I
component ( l , n) or (2, n) with the zonal component of the first mode (1,O).
The lower connections represent the interactions between the three scales
(2, O ) , (1, n),and (2, n).
When the expressions (4.7)-(4.10)are introduced into the equations for
$, T , 8, and u, we obtain (Lorenz, 1963) the spectral form of the equations of
the model
6
(4.24) i i =
$<k=l
a;2(a,Z- a k 2 ) C t j k ( T 1 #k + 7k$j) --aC2wr + k$l - 2kr1
+
6
(4.25) 8%=
f<k=l
c z j k ( d j #k -8k # j ) + OO@t - k(ei - ui) k@t*
6
(4.26) d.0 =- C O t w , -2kuo + k(80 - B0*)
l= 1
(4.28)
u = - 8 d 2 n / ( 1 5 ~ ) ,!? = n2/(n2 1) +
,!?I = (n2+ 3)/(n2+ 4), B” = (n2 - 3)/(n2 + 4)
these equations can be written
A NUMERICAL STUDY O F VACILLATION 137
(4.41) $0 =
6
(4.42) 6,= - 1 eiWi
i=l
(4.53)
nx c4
t g -=
+ 2c6 cos y/L
L c3 + 2c5 cos y / L
The slope with respect to the W-E direction of the trough and ridge lines is
then given by
Consequently, the change with time of the ct coeEcients generally not only
gives rise to the progression of the wave but also to a modification of its
shape. Note that the sign of the slope of the wave pattern does not change
over the interval 0 < y 5 XL and is determined, according to (4.54) and
(4.17'),by the relative position of modes 1 and 2 of the wave n. For instance,
if the wave (2, n ) lags behind the wave ( 1 , n ) , then c4c5 - c3 C g > 0 so that
6y/6x > 0 and the flow pattern exhibits a SW-NE tilt.
respect to the zonal average by primes. I n particular, we have for the zonal u
and meridional v wind components, respectively,
(4.55) v1= u = [u] + u‘, v2 = 2, = [v] + 0’
where obviously
(4.56) [u‘] = [v’] = 0
The mean S-N transport rate of zonal momentum (W-E momentum)
across a latitude circle in a layer of pressure depth of one unit is then given by
(4.57) [vul = [vl[ul+ [V’U’I
The first term [v][u] on the right-hand side of (4.57) is associated with the
existence of a mean meridional circulation [w] a t the considered latitude. The
eddy momentum transport [v‘u‘] is due to the covariance between the
fluctuations of v and u along a latitude circle and results from the eddies.
Recalling the definition (3.46) of V and taking (4.2)-(4.4) into account,
the nondivergent wind a t the mean level p 2 is simply given by
6
(4.58) u$= -a,+= -L2fc+f ayp,
1=1
and
(4.59) v* = a,*= L2f c
6
1=1
*f
(4.60)
and
(4.61) [%I = 0
the zonal average of terms linear in sin(nx/L) or cos(nx/L) being equal to
zero. This yields for the fluctuations:
(4.62)
l =l
Taking (4.58)-(4.63) into account, we obtain for the mean S-N transport
rate of zonal momentum, (4.57),across a latitude circle by the nondivergent
wind a t the mean level:
140 A. QUINET
When the time flows, I&, i,h2, - t&,, varies and, consequently, so does
the latitude of the jet. If 4;. fi2, - 4;. keeps its sign, the maximum
zonal wind remains in the northern region while it will travel across the
center of the channel when +;, 9h2, - t,h1. 4;. changes its sign.
Obviously, the x-dependence of the momentum transport, wu, related to
the presence of the disturbances, creates a longitudinally meandering jet.
Let us also note that, according to (4.64),the transport increases with n, i.e.
with decreasing wavelength.
The correlations between the waves (1, ti) of tlhe $- and 0-fields and between
the waves (2, 71) of the same fields the [terms in sin2 yIL and sin2 2ylL in
(4.68)] determine a systematic nort.hward or southward heat transport at all
latitudes. According t o (4.68)and (4.17) the transport is northward when the
wave ( m , n ) , with m = 1 or 2 , of tjhe temperature field lags behind the same
wave of the stream field. I n cont,rast,,the heat transport associated with the
correlations between two different modes of the wave n of the 4- and &fields
[the term in sin y/L sin 2y/L in (4.68)] changes sign a t the central latitude
y = 7rL/2.
4.4.?. The Globul Forms. The tot(a1potentiaI energy (3.75) being a linear
function of 0 and u, we immediately obtain from (4.9) and (4.10)
(4.71)
(4.72)
(4.74)
+c
6
(4.75) u& = (702 012
I=1
142 A. QUINET
and
+
6
(4.77) = [ci(uo u0m)I C
t=3
@t2
(4.81) aK,/at = c, -C K - Dz
(4.82) aKE/at= CE + CK - DE
The terms appearing on the right sides of (4.78)-(4.82)can be given the follow-
ing interpretation:
(4.83)
(4.85‘)
(4.86’)
A NUMERICAL STUDY OF VACILLATION 143
(4.87)
is the generation rate of A , due to nonadiabatic effects on cro and the refer-
ence state (aom).
(4.91)
(4.92)
(4.93)
where the superscript BT recalls that we are considering only the barotropic
changes of kinetic energy. The coeficients
(4.99) u12=4, aj2=1+n2, ak2=4+n2
A NUMERICAL STUDY OF VACILLATION 145
occur twice with opposite sign so that the total kinetic energy is conserved.
The expression for T is
(4.100) =$Z,O($l, n$k. n - $;, n$z, n) + $2.0(71.n7a, n -Ti, n 7 ~ n).
For given values of c, E", a t , a;, and ak2,the sign of T governs the direction
of the barotropic kinetic energy transfers between the components i, j,and
k of the kinetic energy as in a purely barotropic flow (Fjortoft, 1953). Taking
into account the values of a,2, uT2,and uk2 from (4.99) and recalling the
negative value (4.95) of E", the kinetic energy is transferred from scale (1, n)
toward the scales ( 2 , O ) and (2, n) when T > 0. From (4.100), the sign of T is
determined by the zonal flow of the second mode ( $ z . o and T ~ , and ~ ) the
relative position of waves (1,n) and (2, n) of the $- and fields. For instance,
with t+hZ, > 0, the first group of terms in T contributes positively provided
the wave (1, n) of the $-field lags behind its wave (2, n ) with, according to
(4.17), a maximum contribution when the phase difference between these
waves reaches the value n / 2 . Obviously each group of terms in T may receive
a similar interpretation. Nevertheless, the sign of the whole expression T,
resulting from the contributions of the four groups of terms, cannot be a
priori stated in a simple way.
or
where the asterisk indicates that only the contribution of the transfer between
A l , o and A l , n or A 2 , n to the value of is considered. Recalling that
E and E' have negative values, (4.95), available potential energy is transferred
from scale (1, 0) toward scale (1, n) [or (2, n ) ] if the wave (1, n) [or (2, n)]of
the temperature field lags behind the wave (1, n) [or (2, n ) ]of the stream field.
Here, as everywhere else in this discussion, it is assumed that f'l,o >0, i.e.
the zonal temperature field of the f i s t mode is such that the temperature
decreases northwards. It is well known from linearized perturbation theory
146 A. QUINET
(see, for instance, Thompson, 1961) that the growth of baroclinic disturb-
ances imposes such a configuration of the stream and temperature fields.
Thus, in a purely zonal flow, the transfer of available potential energy from
scale (1, 0) toward scale (1, n ) [or ( 2 , n)] appears as a necessary step in the
conversion of the initially exclusively zonal svailitb1e potential energy into
kinetic energy of the disturbance. According to (4.68) this transfer implies
meridional heat kransport ,
For the additional interactions between scales (2, 0 ) , (1, n), and (2, n ) we
get, from (4.85) and (4.85 ),
Obviously, these transfers conserve the total available potential energy and
each T ican easily be given an interpretation in terms of the flow pattern.
Let us emphasize the completely different structure of the transfers (4.103)-
(4.105)of available potential energy as compared with the barotropic trans-
fers (4.96)-(4.99)of kinetic energy between different scales of motion. I n the
present case, there are three separate eontributions T,,T, , and T3, each
of them appearing twice with an opposite sign. Consequently, and contrary
t o the barotropic transfers of kinetic energy, the same scale can simul-
taneously receive available potential energy from another scale and feed the
third one.
(4.110) = - ~ f & [ l+ (1
(LJK/at)y,cn + n2))ao]-1(2n2+ 1)
x ’31, o(01, n 16;. n - K ,n 161. n)
= (8A/at)Y,cn
resulting from the interaction between scales (1,0) and (1, n) and
= -(aAjat):g
resulting from the interaction between scales (1, 0) and (2, n). The meaning
of Eqs. (4.109)-(4.112) should be well understood. Equations (4.109) and
(4.111) express conversion rates between A l , and Kl, o . However, each of
these processes does not operate individually but is necessarily coupled with
another conversion taking place respectively [Eqs. (4.110) and (4.112)]
between the components (1, n) and (2, n) of A and R.Let us also emphasize
that according to (4.109)-(4.112),an increase of kinetic energy a t one scale
implies a decrease of kinetic energy at the associated scale. I n fact the
following conservation law governs the baroclinic kinetic energy production
in this case:
scales (2, 0), (1, n), and (2, n) (see Fig. 7). Following (4.83) and (4.84), these
conversion rates assume the form
(4.114) (aK/at)E:o = cf&'(l + 4u0)-'
x {(akz + a f z - a j Z ) T l + +ai2 -ak2)TZ}
- -(aA/at)yO
(4.115) (aK/t3t)$',cn
= @d'[l + (1 + n ' ) ~ o ] - '
X {-(ak2+Uj2-U,')T, $ ( a ; +a,2-Uk2)T,}
= -(aA/at)ya
where T,, T , , and T 3 have been defined in (4.106)-(4.108).I n this case, the
following conservation law governs the baroclinic production of kinetic
energy within the three nonlinearly associated components of K .
We have seen that the equations of the model are invariant for a change of
sign of the variables of the second mode, the variables of the first mode being
left unchanged. Consequently, when one solution is obtained, a second
solution always exists which is similar to the first, except for the sign of the
variables of the second mode. The initial conditions of integration decide
which of the solutions develops.
I n order to choose adequately the numerical experiments to be performed
for simulating the two kinds of vacillation delineated by Pfeffer and Chiang
(1967), it is useful to recall the specific characteristics of potential energy
and kinetic energy vacillations. It has been seen that the tilt of the waves
undergoes only minor oscillations in a potential energy vacillation (see
Section 2 ) . Accordingly, the barotropic process of momentum transport
(4.64) can be considered as being of secondary importance in this kind of
flow. However, a “ tilted trough ” vacillation necessarily implies considerable
fluctuations of the meridional transport of west to east momentum and
consequently a marked intervention of a nonsteady barotropic mechanism.
Now it can quite safely be stated that the dominant mechanism of generation
of the waves is of baroclinic character. On the other hand, it has been noted
(Quinet, 1973b) that the higher the rotation rate, the ,relatively greater
becomes the influence of the barotropic kinetic energy transfers. Thus, a t a
given thermal forcing, and assumiDg that with this thermal forcing both kinds
of vacillation are possible, the potential energy vacillation should precede the
kinetic energy vacillation when the rotation rate is gradually increased.
The origin ofthe temperature scale is chosen so that e,*, = 0 and the value
0:. , = 0.25 is used. With the wave n = 3 for the first and second modes, this
thermal forcing warrants the possibility of generating different kinds of
vacillating flows (Quinet, 1973b). Following the arguments of the above
discussion, we shall examine the kind of flow generated a t a ‘‘ low ” rotation
rate and determine if it compares reasonably well with a potential energy
vacillation. Then it will be seen that kinetic energy vacillation occurs at
higher rotation rates.
Let us recall that, according to the definition of k (k= Ff - I ) , the rotation
rate is proportional to k-l.
0 0.2191 0.0147 0.0537 0.0221, 41" 0.2196 -0.0 0.0222, -52" 0.0095, 11" 0.0778
5 0.2199 0.0136 0.0526 0.0222, 38" 0.2203 -0.0006 0.0218, -53" 0.0095, 7" 0.0772
10 0.2204 0.0117 0.0530 0,0210, 34" 0.2206 -0.0013 0.0221, -53" 0.0091, 4O 0.0770
15 0.2204 0.0100 0.0549 0.0190. 32" 0 2203 -0 00x7 0 0229, -53" 0 0083, 3" 0.0773
20 0.2201 0.0087 0.0573 0.0170, 32" 0.2197 -0.0017 0.0238, -52" 0.0074, 4" 0.0779
25 0.2194 0.6983 0.0594 0.0153, 34" 0.2189 -0.0014 0.0246, -51" 0.0067, 6" 0.0787
30 0.2187 0.0086 0.0607 0.0145, 38" 0.2182 -0.0010 0.0250, -51" 0.0064, 9" 0.0793
35 0.2181 0.0096 0.0611 0.0148, 41 ' 0.2179 -0.0005 0.0251, -50" 0.0065, 12" 0.0796
40 0.2179 0.0111 0.0605 0.0160, 44" 0.2178 -0.0001 0.0248, -50" 0.0070, 15" 0.0796
45 0.2179 0.0128 0.0589 0.0179, 45" 0.2181 0.0002 0.0242, -51' 0.0078, 15' 0.0793
50 0.2183 0.0141 0.0568 0.0200, 45" 0.2187 0.0003 0.0233, -51" 0.0087, 14" 0.0788
55 0.2189 0.0145 0.0545 0.0216, 42" 0.2194 0.0 0.0225, -52" 0.0093, 11" 0.0780
56 0.2191 0.0145 0.0541 0.0218, 41" 0.2196 -0.0001 0.0224, - 52" 0.0094, 11" 0.0779
~ _____
a Variables are obsarved in a coordinate system moving with wave (1.3) of the #-field.
152 A. QUINET
1
-0.0 0.000 -0.000
0.01b -0.000 -0.002
0.150 -0.002 -0.006
0.219 -0.004 -0.009
0.215 -0.001 -@.DO6
0.311 -0.008 -0.000
0.315 -0.007 0.006
028b -0.006 0.009
D.2M -0.002 0.006
0.116 -0.000 0.002
- 0 . 2 9 7 - 0 ~ 2 7 ~ - 0 ~ Z ~ 5 - 0 . 2 1 3 - 0 . 2 ~ 0 ~ 2 9 7 - 0 ~ 2 7 6 - 0 ~ 2 b ~ - 0 ~ 2 7 3 - 0 . 2 ~ 0 . 20.081
9~ -0.000 -0.002
0.150 -0.001 -0.005
0.227 -0.003 -0.007
0.280 -0.005 -0.00’)
3
-0.L91-0.297-0.291-0.297-0.297-0.297-0.297-0~297-0~297-0~291-0.297-0~297-0~291 -0.0 0.000 -o.mo
0.082 -OIDOO -0.002
0.159 -0.001 -0.005
4
FIG.8. See facing page for legend.
153
I .o -0.0 0.0
7
FIG.8. Synoptic representation of the $-field during the potential energy vacillation
observed for k = 0.2925, &, = 0.26. Spacing between isolines is 0.1 in L2f units. The
time interval between two successive maps is 9 nondimensional time units to =ft. The
zonal wind in Lf units, the zonally averaged northward W-E momentum transport in
L2faunits, and momentum transport convergence in LJa units are respectively printed
in the three columns at the right of the maps.
154 A. QUINET
wave of the $-field. The periodic character of the flow can be illustrated
by comparing the first and last row of Table I, so that the period T of the
phenomenon is 56 nondimensional time units. It should, however, be men-
tioned that in a fixed reference frame, there is a systematic phase shift on
each wave component of the $- and 8-fields between the beginning and the
end of the period. Accordingly, there is some ambiguity regarding the
definition of the period of the flow as this period depends on the coordinate
system chosen. When only the physical mechanisms of evolution are taken
into consideration, this distinction seems irrelevant. Hence, and in order to
avoid ambiguity, the vacillation period will be considered as given by the
period of a nonwavelike component, namely $2e .z
Table I shows weak fluctuations of the component (0.2179< 2
0.2204)and also rather limited fluctuations of the component (0.0083<
$2, <0.0147). Such a periodic flow where t,b2, oscillates without changing
sign has been called unsymmetric vacillation by Lorenz (1963).
The amplitudes of the waves exhibit cyclic variations, these being more
pronounced for the #-waves, for which they may reach 50 yoofthe amplitude
ofthe (2,3)component. The waves progress one wavelength in approximately
8to,and their relative positions with respect to each other undergo only minor
alterations during the cycle. The 8-field lags behind the $-field by 50 to 53 deg
for the first mode and by 28 to 31 deg for the second mode. As expected, this
configuration points t o a baroclinic origin of the eddies ((4.109)-(4.112)).The
phase difference between the two modes of the wave of the $-field varies
between 32 and 45 deg, the (2,3)wave preceding the (1,3)wave. Accordingly
[(4.54)],the wave pattern tilts SE-NW and there is a systematic southward
momentum transport (4.64) during the whole cycle. The amplitudes of the
wave (1, 3) of the $- and 8-fields reach their extreme values nearly simul-
taneously, as do the amplitudes ofthe wave (2,3) ofthe $- and 8-fields. As a
rule, the lowest values of the amplitude of the waves (1, 3) are attained at
nearly the same time as the maximum amplitude of waves (2, 3), and con-
versely. Consequently, the fluctuation of the amplitude of the global wave 3
+
[waves (1,3) (2,3)]of the $ and 8 fields is reduced to about its lowest value.
The synoptic representation of the stream field a t the mean level is given in
Fig. 8. The spacing of stream lines is 0.10 nondimensional units and the time
interval between two successive maps is 9 time units, the uppermost map
corresponding t o the first TOW of Table I. Except for an eastward translation,
the last map is a repetition of the first. The zonal wind, the zonally averaged
eddy momentum transport, and momentum transport convergence, expressed
respectively in Lf,L2f =,and Lf units, a t latitude y / L = 18'12, with 7t = 0,
It should also be noted that the small phase shift could be due to the numerical
integration scheme.
A NUMERICAL STUDY O F VACILLATION 155
(5.1) u =( v N ~ % , +
s i n ( y / ~ ) 242+,, 0 sin(zy/l))
its maximum remains south of the center of the channel since $2, >0.
The maximum zonal wind oscillates in the narrow latitude belt y/L = 76" a t
t = 0 (or t = T)and y/L = 82" at t = T / 2 , corresponding respectively t o the
maximum (0.0147) and minimum (0.0084) values of o . The small vari-
ations of the zonal wind profile are represented in Fig. 9 where the figures on
c
a
-I 54
U
L
0.1 0.2 0.3
FIG.9. Meridional profile of the zonal wind Corresponding to maps 1 and 4 of Fig. 8.
Latitudes are given in degrees according to (4.1).
the curves refer to the corresponding maps in Fig. 8. The largest zonal wind
maximum is observed on map 1 (and 7) when this maximum occupies its
lowest latitude (76"),and the smallest maximum appears on map 4 where it
reaches its highest latitude (82").
Owing t o the presence of the second mode of wave 3, a distinction should
be made when comparing the flow patterns in the northern and southern
parts of the different maps. It appears then that in the northern part, the
troughs deepen from map 1 to map 4, where well defined closed lows are
observed. I n this respect, map 1 could be considered as characteristic of a
high index circulation and map 4 as corresponding to a low index circulation.
This comparison is consistent with the fluctuations of the zonal wind, the
closed cyclones being associated with relatively weak jets. The southern
part undergoes a similar pulsation, the most intense ridge being observed on
map 1 and then decaying down to map 4.A detailed comparison would be
156 A. QUINET
needed in order t o establish definitely the analogy of the flow presented here
with the potential energy vacillation emphasized by Pfeffer and Chiang
(1967). Let it be simply stated that the nearly steady character of the wave
tilt during its amplitude fluctuation and the fluctuations of the intensity of
the zonal jet during the cycle are important characteristics common to both
phenomena.
The southward transport of west to east momentum reported in the second
column of Fig. 8 is evidently associated with the NW-SE tilt of the waves.
The maximum southward transport occurs on map 1 and then decays,
approximately domi to map 4, where the northern cyclone has developed.
The momentum transport during the cycle is given for the three latitudes
yIL = 54", go", and 126", from bottom to top in Fig. 10a, where the figures
[ v'uq
128' o
-0.01 -0.01
aoi
90" 0
-0ai
aoi
-0.01 -0.01
a C
FIG.10. Time evolution of the zonally averaged (a) northward W-E eddy momentum
transport [v'u'] in Lzfa units; (b) W-E eddy momentum transport convergence
-a[w'u']/ay in Lfa units; and (c) eddy heat transport [w'fl'] in BL3fa units, at the
three latitudes y / L = 54", go", and 126", during the potential energy vacillation observed
a t k = 0.2926, 0:. ,, = 0.25. The figures along the z-axis refer t o the maps of Fig. 8.
along the x-axis refer to the maps of Fig. 8. As imposed by (4.64), there is
maximum southward momentum transport a t the central latitude and
identical weaker values a t the two other latitudes.
The third column of Fig. 8 indicates that there is momentum divergence
north of the center of the channel and, as a consequence of (4.65),momentum
convergence in the south. Accordingly, the southward export rate of west to
east momentum leads to a reduction of the zonal flow in the northern part
and creates a zonal jet in the southern part. Figure 10b gives the time
A NUMERICAL S T U D Y O F VACILLATION 157
variation of -a[v’u‘]/ay during the cycle. The maximum values of the low
latitude momentum transport convergence and of its high latitude diver-
gence arise a t time t = 0 (and t = T), when the zonal wind maximum occupies
its lowest latitude y I L = 76” and reaches its largest value. At time t = TIZ,
the low latitude convergence is minimum, corresponding to the weakest jet
a t the highest latitude y / L = 82”. Accordingly, the zonal jet fluctuations are
strongly correlated with the momentum transport and its convergence.
The heat transport at the three above mentioned latitudes is given in Fig.
1Oc. It is toward the north a t all latitudes and during the whole cycle. The
largest values occur in the region of maximum zonal wind. They are approxi-
mately the same a t 54” and 90” latitude, and roughly half as much a t
y / L = 126”. The heat transport is nearly constant a t low latitude during the
cycle but exhibits fluctuations of approximately the same amplitudes a t the
central and high latitudes, where the fluctuations are in phase. The maximum
heat transport corresponds to map 5, i.e. somewhat later than the time of
occurrence of low index circulation, when the zonal flow is minimum. It
should be noted that the evolution of [u‘e‘] does not show any asymmetry
with respect to the extreme values while Pfeffer et al. (1965)have reported the
existence of such asymmetries in the potential energy vacillation.
The occurrence in time of the extreme values of U , [v‘u’], -a[v’u’]/ay,
’ ] summarized in Table 11, where M stands for “maximum ” and
and [ v ’ I ~is
m for “minimum.” Since, a t a given latitude, these quantities do not change
their sign during the cycle, the modulus only has been considered for labeling
the extreme values.
Maps 1 2 3 4 5 6 7
~
U M m M
[w u l M m M
-a[v u ]/ay M m M
[w’e’~ m M
aS9
0.68
5
10 20 30 40 50
FIG.11. Time evolution of the available potential energy A and of the kinetic energy
K , expressed in 2n2p0 g-lL4f a units, during the potential energy vacillation observed
at k = 0.2925, 8:. = 0.25.
1.53
1.52
1.51
0.01
0.21
020
0.19
FIG.12. Time evolution of the zonal A , and eddy A , available potential energy and
of the zonal K , and eddy K , kinetic energy, expressed in 2rrapo g-'Lty a units, during
the potential energy vacillation observed at k = 0.2925, 8:. = 0.25.
A NUMERICAL STUDY O F VACCILLATION 159
during the cycle. The striking feature is the nearly perfect phase opposition
between the two curves although nonadiabatic processes are taking place.
The fluctuations of A are of greater amplitude than those of K .
Figure 12 gives the graphic representation of A , , A , , K , , and K , during
the cycle. A , and K , undergo the major oscillations while A , is nearly
constant. As a consequence of the very intense zonal thermal forcing, A , is
two orders of magnitude greater than A,; K , is approximately one third of
A , and K , one order of magnitude greater than A , . I n opposition t o the
curves of A and K , the A , and K , curves or the A , and K , curves are nearly
in phase, so that any increase of A , (AE)is accompanied by a simultaneous
increase of K , ( K , ) .
I n order to investigate the nature of the energetics of the flow, Fig. 13
gives the evolution of the various terms of the energy budgets (4.79)-(4.82).
Clearly C, is the dominant conversion term, so that the zonal kinetic energy
is essentially maintained against dissipation by conversion from A , . I n lesser
proportion A , is also transferred into A , , by C, and C,, , which, in turn, is
converted (C, >0 ) into K Ea t an important rate. Accordingly, there must be
a considerable generation of A , by heating, G, , feeding both C, and C, CAR.+
Evidently, without any longitudinally distributed heat source, GE < 0 [see
(4.88)]. The kinetic energy transfers are toward the zonal flow ( C , < 0) but
the contribution of this term is two orders of magnitude less than C, so that,
as expected, the barotropic kinetic energy transfers are extremely weak.
FIG.13. Time evolution of the different components of the energy budgets [see Eqs.
(4.79)-(4.82) for definitions], expressed in 2napOg-lL4f3units, during the potential
energy vacillation observed at k = 0.2926, 52., = 0.26.
160 A. QUINET
FIG.14. Time evolution of T, TI,T z , and T3[see Eqs. (4.100) and (4.106)-(4.108)
for defitions] during the potential energy vacillation observed at k = 0.2926, a:, =
0.26.
appears then to result from the fact that only the self-interaction terms
(4.101), (4.102),and (4.109)-(4.112) come into play in the energy processes.
The term T being positive, there is a permanent transfer from Kl,
toward K z , o and K l , 3 . On the other hand, A l , 3 is transferred toward
,
A,. ( T1<0) but chiefly toward A z , (T,> 0) while the transfers between
A z , and A,, are extremely small (T, 2: 0). Let us finally note that, re-
garding the role of the (2, 0 ) , (1, 3), and (2, 3) interactions, the barotropic
processes, although very weak in comparison with the self-interaction
contributions, are the dominant ones.
Figure 15 describes schematically the energy cycle of the potential energy
vacillation; the values indicated on the arrows represent mean values over
one period.
14.1
0.2
t -cK
1
- / G ~ + IG 1.1
~ ~
FIG.15. Energy diagram averaged over one period of the potential energy vacillation
observed at k = 0.2925, 0:. , = 0.26. Energies are expressed in c = 2m2p,g-1L4f units,
the conversion and transfer rates are expressed in cf units.
One of the major deficiencies of the simulated flow with respect to labor-
atory potential energy vacillation is the symmetric character of the heat
transport during the cycle and the relatively weak fluctuations of the ampli-
tudes of the waves. Once it has been recognized that potential energy vacil-
lation involves essentially baroclinic energy exchanges, it is possible to
obtain intense potential energy vacillittion a t a high rotation rate by simply
not including the barotropic energy exchanges in the model. Such a model,
with the correct cylindrical annular geometry, has been dealt with by
Merilees (1972). If high amplitude potential energy vacillation can indeed be
simulated in this way, the heat transport nevertheless remains symmetric
during the cycle. The introduction of viscosity and heat conductivity into
the numerical model would improve the results. It has indeed been observed
that amplitude vacillation is most common with highly viscous fluids (Fowlis
and Hide, 1965). However, whether these physical factors will introduce in
the model the specific effects capable of leading t o asymmetries in the heat
transfer cycle remains an open question.
152 A. QUINET
5.3.1. The Dynamics ofthe Kinetic Energy VmiUation. We now describe the
results of a numerical experiment performed with the same thermal forcing
6;. =0.25 as in the previous case, but a t a higher rotation rate, k = 0.275.
Table 111lists the values of the flow variabbles for every five time steps in a
TABLE111. Numerical integration of the model for k = 0.275, 0;. = 0.25a
P
to 41.0 *% 0 41.3 4 2 ,3 81.0 e2. el. e2. 0 0
w
a
0 0.2186 -0.0294 0.0458 0.0336, -122" 0.2188 -0.0053 0.0188, -55' 0.0136, -156" 0.0782 3
*3
5 0.2203 -0.0225 0.0339 0.0357, -151" 0.2223 -0.0014 0.0138, -58" 0.0146, 175' 0.0746
10 0.2230 -0.0084 0.0366 0.0296, -177" 0.2246 0.0035 0.0156, -57" 0.0120, 150' 0.0726
15 0.2241 0.0030 0.0470 0.0211, 165" 0.2239 0.0067 0.0206, -56" 0.0080, 135" 0.0738 F
20 0.2225 0.0125 0.0572 0.0156, 126" 0.2206 0.0073 0.0245, -54" 0.0052, 95" 0.0774
!
25
30
0.2192
0.2184
0.0248
0.0296
0.0570
0.0462
0.0249,
0.0337,
77'
58'
0.2176
0.2186
0.0065
0.0054
0.0237, -53"
0.0190, -55"
0.0095,
0.0136,
41"
24"
0.0798
0.0784 *
U
0
35 0.2201 0.0227 0.0339 0.0359, 29" 0.2222 0.0015 0.0137, -58" 0.0147, -5' 0.0747 w
40 0.2230 0.0085 0.0365 0.0296, 3" 0.2246 -0.0035 0,0155, -57" 0.0120, -30" 0.0726 2
45
50
0.2241
0.2226
-0.0031
-0.0126
0.0469
0.0570
0.0212, -15"
0.0158, -54"
0.2239
0.2207
-0.0067
-0.0073
0.0205, -56"
0.0245, -54"
0.0080, -45'
0.0052, -85'
0.0737
0.0773
8
55 0.2197 -0.0230 0.0581 0.0227, -98" 0.2179 -0.0067 0.0243, -53" 0.0085, -134' 0.0797 F-
60 0.2185 -0.0296 0.0458 0.0338, -122" 0.2187 -0.0054 0.0188, -55" 0.0136, -156' 0.0783
!+-?I
Variables are observed in a coordimte system moving with wave ( 1 , 3) of the #-field.
164 A. QUWET
1
-0.0 -O.DOO 0.000
0.111 0.000 0.000
0.201 0.000 O.Wl
2
-0.0 0.000 -0.000
3
-0.2b6-3.266-~.266-0.266-6.266-0.266-0.266-0~2b6-0~266-0.266-0.266-0~266-0~~66 -0.0 0.000 -0.000
4
FIG.16. See facing page for legend
A NUMERICAL STUDY OF VACILLATION 165
5
-~.332-~.332-5.332-J.332-L.332-0.332-0.30~1~~-B~332-0~332 -0.0 -0.000 0.000
0.118 0.000 0.002
0.218 0.002 0.007
0.296 0.296 0.296 0.296 0.296 0.29b 0.296 0.296 D.29b O.29b 0.2Pb 0.296 0.296 0.0 -0.0 0.0
6
-0.0 -0.000 0.000
0.1.4 0.000 0.00k
..ZIU 0.293 J.283 J.Zk9 ~ . 2 2 >0.236 ( - 2 1 3 0.291 0.203 D.Zk9 0 . 1 2 5 0.23b 0.21) 0.0kb 0.000 -0.00k
1.266 J.Zb6 0.2bh 3.1bb ~ . 2 h b 3.2hh 0.2bb 0.266 0.261. D.266 0.2bb 0.Zbb 0 . 2 b S 0.0 -0.0 0.0
FIG.16. Synoptic representation of the #-field during the kinetic energy vacillation
observed a t k = 0.275, 8: = 0.25. Spacement between isolines is 0.1 in L2f units. The
time interval between two successive maps is 10 nondimensional time units to = j t . The
zonal wind in Lf units, the zonally averaged S-N momentum transport in L2j2units,
and the momentum transport convergence in Lf2 units respectively, ere, printed on the
three columns at the right of the maps.
166 A. QUINET
coordinate system moving with the wave (1, 3) of the #-field. The flow is
still periodic, the period being 60t0.The increase of the rotation rate entails a
considerable increase of the fluctuations of the variables in comparison with
the previous case. The component #2, reaches extreme symmetric values of
-0.0294 (to = 0, to = 2') and t0.0296 (to= 30) so that this kind of flow has
been termed by Lorenz (1963) a symmetric vacillation. The waves (1, 3)
and (2, 3) of the $-field progress one wavelength in approximately 74t0 and
89t0 respectively, but these periods undergo small fluctuations during the
cycle, especially for the (2, 3) component. Again, a t each mode, the &field
lags behind the #-field. The phase shift between the $- and 8-waves has been
increased and varies for the (I, 3) and (2, 3) waves between 53" and 58" and
between 28" and 37", respectively. The amplitudes of the (1, 3) and (2, 3)
components of the $-field are still negatively correlated but their phase shift
may now vary over 277. Accordingly there are intense fluctuations of the
barotropic processes, especially of the momentum transport (4.64) which
changes sign during the cycle.
The synoptic representation of the stream field a t the mean level is given
in Fig. 16. Spacing between stream lines is still 0.1 nondimensional units and
the time interval between two successive maps is 10 nondimensional time
units. Except for an eastward translation of approximately one sixth of the
wavelength, map 7 is a repetition of map 1. It can be seen now that the trough
and ridge lines undergo substantial oscillations, characteristic of a '' tilted
trough" or kinetic energy vacillation. The wave tilts from SW to NE on
maps 1 (and 7) and 6 and tilts from SE t o NW on maps 3 and 4 while the
waves are symmetric on maps 2 and 5. Let us already point out that the
symmetric configuration precedes the maximum tilt (maps 1 and 4) by 20
time units and follows it by 10 time units only.
The zonal wind, the zonally averaged eddy momentum transport, and the
eddy momentum transport convergence are given on the right side of the
maps of Fig. 16 as in Fig. 8. The maximum zonal wind occurs to the north of
the center of the channel on map 1 (and 7 ) when the waves are tilting north-
east and when there is a northward transport of W-E momentum through
the whole width of the channel. At this time there is momentum transport
convergence to the north of the center of the channel and momentum trans-
port divergence to the south. The situation is reversed on map 4, the south-
ward momentum transport converging south of the center of the channel
where the maximum zonal wind is located. Between these two situations, but
not midway, the momentum transport and the momentum transport con-
vergence vanish a t all latitudes (maps 2 and 5).
The negative values of the momentum transport observed after map 2 are
associated with the deepening of the waves, generating high latitude cyclones
which are established on map 3, somewhat before the time of the maximum
A NUMERICAL STUDY OF VACILLATION 167
zonal jet of map 4.Similarly, positive values of the momentum transport are
associated with amplifying low latitude highs.
The zonal flow profile is given in Fig. 17 where the figures on the different
curves refer t o the corresponding map of Fig. 16. The extreme latitudes of the
maximum zonal wind are respectively 112" on map 1 (and 7) and 67" on
map 4,when the waves reach their maximum tilt. At these times, the zonal
flow is barotropically unstable for small linear perturbations, the zonal wind
profile presenting an inflection point on Fig. 17. This is not without suggesting
an explanation for the rapid reestablishment of the symmetric configuration
of maps 2 and 5 after the time of maximum tilt.
180
t
162
-p 144
126
-
0
0
108
0 90
3
.=
4-
72
m
4 54
36
18
FIQ.17. Meridional profile of the zonal wind corresponding to maps 1 to 7 of Fig. 16.
Latitudes are given in degrees according to (4.1);the inflection point is at 63" and 117'
on curves 1 and 4, respectively.
The fast evolution after the occurrence of a n unstable zonal wind profile
is particularly well represented in Fig. 18 which is the analog of Fig. 10.
Northward or southward eddy momentum transport is simultaneously
observed at the three latitudes of 54",go", and 126" while high latitude
momentum transport convergence is balanced by low latitude divergence,
and conversely. As noted by Fultz, the maximum value of [u’v’] is located
a t the middle latitude. I n the model considered here, this circumstance is
necessarily a consequence of (4.64).
There is considerable asymmetry on each of the curves of Figs. 18a and
lBb, the extreme values, corresponding to maps 1 and 4,being slowly reached
and then rapidly left. This allows one to give the following interpretation of
the momentum evolution during the cycle: the momentum transport con-
vergence associated with the tilting of the waves tends to remove the jet
from the center of the channel, where the thermal forcing would locate it.
168 A. QUINET
FIG.18. Time evolution of the zonally averaged (a)northward W-E eddy momentum
transport [ v ' d ] in Lafa units; (b) W-E eddy momentum transport convergence
-a[v'~']/& in Lfa units; and (c) eddy heat transport [v’e] in BL3f units, at the three
latitudes v / L = 64', go", and 126" during the kinetic energy vacillation observed at
k = 0.276, el,,, = 0.26. The f i p e s on the z-axis refer to the corresponding maps of
Fig. 16.
wind in the northern and southern part of the channel, respectively, when the
momentum transport and the momentum transport convergence through
the whole width vanish. Likewise, as in laboratory experiments, the minimum
heat transport at a given latitude follows the minimum momentum conver-
gence at this latitude. As for the potential energy vacillation, the relative
positions of the times of occurrence of the extreme values of U , [u'u'],
-a[u'u']/ay, and [u'e'] are schematically shown in Table IV. M stands for
Maps 1 2 3 4 5 6 7
The region of location of the extreme value, north (N) or south (S) of the center of
the channel, is also indicated.
0.16
0.14
0.48
10 20 30 40 50 60
FIG.20. Time evolution of the zonal A , and eddy AE available potential energy and
of the zonal K , and eddy K Ekinetic energy, expressed in 2+po g-IL4ja units, during
the kinetic energy vacillation observed at k = 0.276, 8
:. = 0.25.
A NUMEXICAL STUDY OF VACILLATION 171
The conversion rate C , is still the dominant term in Fig. 21, which corres-
ponds t o Fig. 13. Each curve now exhibits two sequences of maximum and
minimum, the first sequence corresponding t o -0.0294 J / z , < +0.0296
and the second one to 0.0296 2 i+hz. 2 -0.0296. Except for an increase of
the fluctuations, there is great qualitative similarity between Fig. 13 and
Fig. 21 regarding the behavior of Gz , Cz, C, , C A, CAR,Dz, and D, . Accord-
ingly, as in the potential energy vacillation, so the self-interactions of the
waves (1,3)and (2,3)with the zonal thermal field (1,O)remain the dominant
contributions to baroclinic energy processes in the kinetic energy vacillation.
FIG.21. Time evolution of the different components of the energy budgets [see Eqs.
(4.79)-(4.82) for definitions], expressed in 2rrap0g- lL4f3 units, during the kinetic
energy vacillation observed at Ic = 0.275, 8;. = 0.25.
,
K 2 , is a barotropic energy transfer from K l , . This actually is the reason
why T is positive; in this sense, the flow is barotropically stable. Thus the
rate of increase or decrease of K z , or, considered a t the mean level, of t,b2.
is mainly governed by the respective increase or decrease of T.
It is easily seen that the linear condition of barotropic instability
d2U/dya= 0 assumes the form
FIQ.22. Time evolution of T, T,,T,, and T3[see Eqs. (4.100) and (4.106)-(4.108)
for definitions] during the kinetic energy vacillation observed at k = 0.275, 6:. a = 0.25.
transfers are still the dominant energetic processes. I n contrast with the self-
interaction terms, the terms T and particularly T I ,T,, and T,are extremely
weak. Nevertheless, their contributions are now sufficient to introduce the
observed shifts between the curves of A , , A , , K , , and K , of Fig. 20. Owing
to the weak values of A , , indicating that the dominant self-interaction
transfers from A , are nearly entirely converted into K , , the influence of
T,,T,, and T 3 is most marked on the A , curve which exhibits noticeable
asymmetries.
Figure 23, where the numbers on the arrows represent mean values over
one period, schematically describes the energy cycle of the flow. Actually,
there is little difference between Fig. 15 and Fig. 23. This shows how the
averaging process can smooth important aspects of the energy cycle since
we know that the role of the C , term is quite different in both cases.
13.4
FIG.23. Energy diagram averaged over one period of the kinetic vacillation observed
at k = 0.275, 6:. a = 0.25. Energies are given in c = 27r2pag-’L4f2 units; the conversion
and transfer rates are expressed in cf units.
174 A. QUINET
-0.01 t
( aI
the model are invariant for a change of sign of the second mode variables, the
variables of the first mode being left unchanged, there also exists an other
unsymmetric vacillation cycle whose representation would be the image of
Fig. 24a with respect t o the ot,41s ,-axis. The initial conditions of integration
decide which one of the possible circulations is ultimately realized. The
same, of course, applies to each curve of Fig. 24.
When the rotation rate is increased, the symmetric vacillation, discussed in
Section 5.3, develops. The flow represented in Pig.' 24b corresponds to
,
0:. = 0.25 and k = 0.275 and has a period of BOt, .
At still higher rotation rates, the model performs an asymmetric vacillation
,
showninFig. 24c, corresponding to 0:. = 0.25, k = 0.225, andaperiod of 40t,.
I n this flow, t,h2, changes sign during the cycle but reaches extreme values
of different moduli. The characteristics of the curves associated with the
energy processes of the asymmetric vacillation are similar to those of the
symmetric vacillation except that there are now two different maxima
(and two different minima) on each curve.
For 0:,,=0.25 and k=0.2 the model exhibits still another type of
vacillation, shown in Fig. 24d, which may be called a double asymmetric
178 A. QUINET
,
vacillation, the period of which is 67t,. At 0:. = 0.25 and k = 0.15, the
single asymmetric vacillation has reappeared (not shown in Fig. 24).
In the course of this investigation, keeping the thermal forcing constant
el,, = 0.25, the amplitude of the vacillation increases with increasing
rotation rate. On the other hand, the period of vacillation, referred to one
loop, decreases when the rotation rate increases.
For the three experiments performed at k = 0.25, k = 0.225, and k = 0.2
,
with a weaker thermal forcing 0;. =0.175, the model exhibits a do&&
symmetric vacillation shown in Fig. 24e, which corresponds to k = 0.25. The
period of vacillation is 1396,. Comparing this period with the corresponding
,
case at 0:. = 0.25 indicates that, as could be expected, the reduction of the
heat to be transported associated with the reduction of the thermal contrast
at the lateral boundaries induces a longer vacillation period.
At still lower thermal forcing, the numerical experiments using the wave
?a = 3 would become questionable since experimentation and theory both
show that the flow is then controlled by shorter waves.
To sum up, the model is able to simulate at least five different kinds of
vacillation: (a) unsymmetric vacillation, (b) symmetric vacillation, (c)
asymmetric vacillation, (d) double asymmetric vacillation, (e) double sym-
metric vacillation. The analytic description of tliese flows, if ever possible,
would presumably be increasingly complex. The driving energy mechanisms,
however, can be reasonably believed to be of the same kind. It should
nevertheless be kept in mind that the relative as well as the absolute impor-
tance of the various terms of the energy budgets (4.79)-(4.82) is modified
when varying the thermal forcing and the rotation rate. I n this respect, it is
interesting to note that the mean value flz of C, during one vacillation period
drops considerably with increasing rotation rates. For instance, at the given
,
thermal forcing 0: = 0.25, flz at k = 0.15 is only one half of fl, at k = 0.275.
This confirmsthe qualitative argument mentioned in Section 2, that the higher
the rotation rate, the more geostrophic will be the flow. Moreover, it is
observed that the influence of the nonlinear interactions between the scales
(2.0), (1, 3)) and (2, 3) increases with the rotation rate. Accordingly, at high
rotation rates, the curves of A , , A , , K , , and K , become less correlated
with each other, and the respective times of occurrenceof their extreme values
exhibit more or less important shifts.
6. VACILLATION
IN TEE ATMOSPHERE
DAY 1
DAY 15
FIG.25. Comparison between an atmospheric index circulation change (after Winston
and Krueger, 1961) and the extreme stages of an amplitude vacillation generated in a
rotating annulus experiment (courtesy of Pfeffer and colleagues, 1969).
FIG.26. Maps drawn in retaining the zonal harmonic components (2, 0 ) , (4,0 ) , (6, 0 ) ,
and the four-harmonics (4, 4),( 6 , 4 ) , and (8,4), of the 500 mbar geopotential field during
the period 4 February-22 February 1969 and showing the existence of an atmospheric
kinetic energy vacillation cycle.
182 A, QUINET
critically upon the intensity of the zonal flow. Returning to Section 5 of this
monograph, there is no doubt that the meridional profile of the zonal wind is
also of importance in this respect.
6.3.Conclusion
The two examples of Figs. 25 and 26 amply demonstrate that vacillation
is not only a characteristic laboratory flow closely related to the large-scale
atmospheric circulation but has also an intrinsic pragmatic aspect. A clear
synoptic identification of initial conditions leading to atmospheric vacillation
would be a first step in making economic long range weather predictions, a t
least in favorable circumstances. Moreover, it is believed that a highly
truncated numerical weather prediction model would provide, in a rather
short computation time, a meaningful objective long range forecast of the
large-scale atmospheric flow.
ACKNOWLEDQMENTS
LISTOF SYMBOLS
A Available potential energy Transfer rate of K, into K,
of the system Conversionrate of A, into K Z
A , Eddy available potential 2rap,g-'L4fa; is used as
energy energy unit
A , Zonal available potential Specific heat of dry air at
energy constant pressure
+
a [(3/4)" (1/4)K]/2N 0.797 Interaction coefficient [see
- a t a Eigenvalue of the Laplacian Eq. (4.20)]
operator in Cartesian Dissipation rate of K E by
coordinates friction
B b-lc-lf Dissipation rate of Kz by
b [(3/4)' - (1/4)E]/2N 0.124 friction
C A Transfer rate of A z into A, Contrav&riant and covariant
resulting from sensible heat components of the velocity
advection of the reference body with
CAR Transfer rate of Az into A, respect to an absolute
resulting from changes of reference body (entrain-
static stability in time ment velocity)
CE Conversion rate of A, into K , e-symbol [see Eq. (3.36)]
A NUMERICAL STUDY OF VACILLATION 183
INDICES
I n the tensorial expressions, the Roman indices take the values 1 and 2, the Greek
indices take the values 1 to 3. They are summation indices when repeated in the same
term.
In Section 3, subscripts 0, 2, and 4 refer respectively to levels p, = 100 cbar, p, = po/2,
end p4 = 0 cbar; subscripts 1 and 3 refer to the intermediate levels p, = 3po/4 and p, =
po/4, respectively.
Subscripts to the scalar dependent variables #, T , 0, u denote spectral components
[see Eqs. (4.7)-(4.10)].
REFERENCES
Bolin, B. (1962). Studies of the general circulation of the atmosphere. Advan. &ophys.
1, 87-118.
Charney, J. (1947). The dynamics of long waves in a baroclinic westerly current. J.
Meteorol. 4, 136-163.
Davies, T. (1963). The forced flow of a rotating viscous liquid which is heated from
below. Phil. Trans. Roy. SOC.London, Ser. A 246, 81-112.
Davies, T. (1969). On the forced motion due to heating of a deep rotating liquid in an
annulus. J . Fluid Meoh. 5, 693-621.
Defrise, P. (1964). Tensor calculus in atmospheric mechanics. Advan. Geophya. 10,
261-314.
D6i)s, B. (1969). The influence of the large-scale heat sources on the dynamics of the
ultra-long waves. Tellue 21, 26-39
A NUMERICAL STUDY OF VACILLATION 185
.
1 Introduction .......................................................... 187
.
2 Convolution Filtering .................................................. 189
2.1. Definition of Convolution Filtering .................................. 189
2.2. The Frequency Response .......................................... 191
2.3. Linear. Discrete Filters ............................................ 192
2.4. Construction of Linear. Discrete Filters in the (2.y)-Plane ............ 195
2.5. Construction of Linear. Discrete Filters in the (u.w)-Plane .............. 200
3 . Upward and Downward Continuation of the Surface Gravity Effect .......... 203
3.1. Definition of the Surface Uravity Effect .............................. 203
3.2. The Upward Continuation a8 a Filtering Operation .................... 205
3.3. Construction of a Numerical Upward Continuation Filter .............. 210
3.4. The Downward Continuation as a Filtering Operation .................. 213
3.6. Construction of a Numerical Downward Continuation Filter ............ 219
4 . Frequency Filtering .................................................... 226
4.1. Procedure for Filtering in the Frequency Plane ........................ 226
4.2. Optimal Wiener Filtering .......................................... 228
4.3. Strakhov’s Method for Extraction of Potential Field Signal ............ 233
4.4. Digitization of a Continuous Field-Aliasing .......................... 237
4.5. Estimation of the Power Spectrum .................................. 240
4.6. Convolution Filtering versus Frequency Filtering ...................... 244
.
5 Calculation of Derivatives of Higher Order ................................ 248
Appendices ............................................................ 250
List of Symbols ........................................................ 254
References ............................................................ 256
1. INTRODUCTION
One of the most important problems in the interpretation of gravity meas-
urements is that of separating a surface field. derivable from a potential. into
independent components and of ascribing separate geological structures to
these parts . The geological interpretation of gravity anomalies therefore
consists largely of estimating the positions and shapes of the disturbing
masses in the upper part of the earth’s crust and of determining the density
structure of the area in which they are imbedded .
I n this respect gravity interpretation uses the whole of the following
procedures: (1) A gravity survey yields values of the gravitational field
over a limited part of the earth’s surface. (2) Bouguer corrections are applied
to allow for the topography of the survey area and for the attraction of the
187
188 FRANS DE MEYER
earth’s spheroid; the residue, the Bouguer anomaly, reflects the hetero-
geneous structure of the upper part of the crust. (3) The irregularly spaced
gravity data are interpolated onto a regdar (rectangular or square) grid,
for ready entry to a computer, and are automatically contoured. (4)A
regional-residualanalysisis applied, which separates the field into components
of larger and smaller extent. ( 5 ) Several interpretation techniques are used
for obtaining a better insight into the composition of the field, such as filtering
the surface field, calculationofthe vertical derivatives, upward and downward
continuation. (6) A model-fitting technique is applied in order to obtain a
geological model that could produce the observed part of the surface field.
It is a fact that a gravimeter, measuring the variations in the vertical
component of a potential field, is sensitive enough to register the local effects
of many types of geological configurations. Frequently the data are subjected
to elaborate reductions and inaccurate numerical approximation methods;
consequently they are not exact and are seldom precise. Finally we have a
map and a distribution of data on a regular grid, giving a more or less com-
plete picture of the behavior of the field a t the earth’s surface and of the in-
ternal mass distribution in the earth’s crust.
Even if the surface field were known very accurately, there remains an
inherent lack of determinacy of the source. Indeed, any gmvitational field
possesses two characteristics, preventing a unique interpretation. The finst
difficulty arises from the fact that the reduced anomaly at each observation
point undergoes the influence of a very complex mass distribution in the
upper part of the crust, and the attraction of local, shallow structures is
often seen as a small deviation in the broad picture of the regional features
of the map. The effects caused by these disturbing masses are of course in-
distinguishable, but usually we can assume that they are independent of one
another, stating implicitly that they are considered as being random, affecting
individually only a single observation point.
The second difficulty results from the property t>hatany gravity field,
derivable from a potential, implies the inherent ambiguity in defining the
source of the potential field (Skeels, 1947). The distribution of the field in free
space can be calculated uniquely, since the upward continuated field satisfies
Laplace’s equation, with known Dirichlet’s conditions in the earth’s surface.
However, if knowledge of the field at a given depth is desired, then we require
the solution of Poisson’s equation with unknown density function. It is well
known that the gravitational field is not in itself sufficient to define the mass
distribution which produces it: for a given gravity field, measured at the
earth’s surface, an infinite number of mass distributions can be found, all
accounting for that field. Even within the limits of some known physical
parameters an infinite variety of solutions is possible and no degree of pre-
cision or amount of data w ill remove this fundamental ambiguity.
FILTER TECHNIQUES IN QRAVPTY INTERPRETATION 189
2. CONVOLUTIONFILTERING
2.1. DeJinition of Convolution Filtering
We consider the class 8 of the continuous, indefinitely derivable functions
f (2,y) of the coordinates x and y, with the property that the following norm
is finite
This simply states the fact that the output of the linear filter 9 from a sum
of inputs is equal to the sum of the outputs of the filter, with each input
applied separately. *
(2) The operator .F commutates with the translation operator r e ,11 defined
by its action on a function f (2,y) of 8
(2.5) TC. , f h Y) =f (z - & Y - rl)
which means that
(2.6) 9 7 ~n =. 7 t en .F
This property implies that the filter behavior is independent of the origin of
the (2,y)-plane: if g(x, y) is the response of the filter to a n input f (2,y),
190 FRANS DE MEYER
then g(x -6, y - q ) will be the response to the input f(x - [, y - q), for
any 6 and q. Indeed, applying both sides of Eq. (2.6) to the input f (x,y)
gives
9% )) = %{f (Z - I ,Y - $1
n{f(X, Y
and
Tt. R R{f(Z,Y)) =7t, ng(x3 Y) = 9(x - r, Y - q)
Equality yields
~b(f(Z--B,Y--rl)}=g(x’:6,Y -71)
I n the theory of gravitational interpretation the filter % is usually defined
by a two-dimensional convolution integral of the form
where the weighting function h(x, y) is called the impulse response or filter
function and it describes the behavior of the filter in the coordinate plane
(x,Y).
If we let the W a c delta distribution S(x,y) be a member of the class Y
and if we apply &x, y) as an input to the filter (2.7), then it immediately
follows that
g(z, Y) = IW
jmh(5,rl)
-m - w
- 6 Y - 9) d17 = h(X7 Y)
Therefore we conclude that the filter function h(x,y) may be regarded as the
response of the filter to the Dirac impulse function S(x, y).
It often happens that the impulse response is circularly symmetrical, so
that h(s,y) is a function of the radius variable r
(2-8) h(x, y) = h(r) where r2 = x2 + y2
Transforming t o polar coordinates (z- 6) + i( y - q) = rei6, Eq. (2.7) can be
written in the equivalent form
where
FILTER TECHNIQUES M GRAVITY INTERPRETATION 191
is the average of the functionf (x,y) in the coordinate plane (2, y) on the circle
of radius T with center a t the point (2,y).
where 4271 and v/27r are the frequencies in cycles per unit length in the x-
and y-directions, respectively. If we assume that the Fourier transforms
F(u, v), G(u, v) and H(u, v) of the respective input, output, and fdter function
of the convolution filter (2.7) exist, i.e. if the functions of the class 9 satisfy
Dirichlet's conditions in any finite domain and are absolutely integrable,
then we obtain from the convolution theorem of Fourier transforms the
following relation between the signal and response
(2.13) G(u, W) = H(u, v)F(u,
V)
where
--a)
n(x,y)e-*(Uz+"u)dz dy
and the continuous filter function h(x, y) is now replaced by a discrete set of
filter weights hkg.In this case the frequency response of the discrete filter
(2.18) is given by the analogous form of (2.14)
M N
(2.19) H,(u, u)= A x A y 1 1- Nhk,e-t(kuAs+
k= -M 1=
IUAy)
(2.20)
FILTER TECHNIQUES IN GRAVITY INTERPRETATION 193
1 I 1 I I l ~ l l l - l - - t l i I I 1 1 1
FIG.1. Square integretion grid in the (5,y)-plane.
with weights h k , and R, the radii of circles passing through the points of
intersection of a square integration grid (see Fig. 1).
We now derive the explicit form of the frequency response of the discrete
filter, as defined by Eq. (2.20). Substituting (2.10) into (2.20) we obtain
(2.26)
For a square grid, nk is a n even number; every grid point on the circle of
radius Rk defines another point, having coordinates of opposite sign. There-
fore the sum in Eq. (2.26) can be written as
or,
(2.27)
FILTER TECHNIQUES IN GRAVITY INTERPRETATION 195
I n conclusion, one can say that the frequency response of the fllter, that
consists of averaging f ( x , y) over a finite number n, of points on a circle of
radius r , is given by
nria
(2.28) H J u , v) = (2/n,)
f=l
+
cos(u~, vy,), +
xj2 y? = r2
(2.30) pN =2/5TlS0
These are the cutoff frequencies, induced by the digital profile and they are
controlled by the grid spacing.
Figure 2 shows the differences between the forms (2.22) and (2.28) in the
Nyquist domain 0 5 u 2 u N ,0 < v < v, of the frequency plane for sr= 4
and n, = 8 points, distributed equidistantly over the circle of radius r.
It was found that the differences are less than 0.01 % over the Nyquist
domain for n, = 12 and n, = 16 points on the circles and this result is nearly
independent of the distribution of the points on the circles. From Fig. 2 it
follows that the largest deviations for n, = 8 points is 1.7 o/o in the point (m, T)
and significant deviations occur a t four-point averaging (about 30 %). I n
consequence one may expect that averaging over eight and more points
yields a representative estimation of the true circle average; a, significant
deviation of the exact circle average occurs a t four-point averaging and these
deviations are mainly situated in the high frequency region of the Nyquist
domain.
I
I I I
1 2
u 3 1
(b)
FIG.2. Deviations for (a) n, = 4 points, contour interval 2 %; (b) n, = 8 points, con-
tour interval 0.1 %.
FILTER TECHNIQUES IN GRAVITY INTERPRETATION 197
is approximated by
0 PC pk P
For the function k,(p) one can use one of the following kernels:
FQjerkernel U p ) = [sin 4 P - P C ) b sin(p - PC)l2
Jackson kernel U p ) = [sin .(P - PC)b s i d p - Pc)l4
(2.32)
Abel-Poisson kernel k,(p) = 1/{1 + [a(p - pc)]'}
Weierstrass kernel k,(p) = eXp[-E(p - pc)']
For the kernel do@)one can apply the following relations for the zero-order
Bessel function (Watson, 1958, p. 134)
(2.41) (p' = p ) p , ( p z ) J o * ( p Z ) z dz
= i t ~ " ~ , ( f z ) J o * ( p ~-
) J -l(pz)Jl*(pz) - J ~ , ( p z ) J 1 ( p z ) l
for any complex number z, in order to obtain
(2.42)
(p' f p) Do(p; p ' ) =R[p'J,(Rp')Jo(Rp) - p J 0 ( ~ P ' ) J 1 ( ~ p ) l / ( p -' f2a )
(p' = p) D o h p ) =4 R " J o 2 ( ~ p )+J12(RP)l
The expression (2.9) for the output field is now approximated by
I n order t o meet the property that the filter coefficients should add u p t o
unity, let R be the solution of the equation
which lies nearest to the outer integration circle of radius R, of the chosen
integration grid. Hence, substituting (2.34) and (2.35) into (2.44) one obtains
PC
(2.45) W )= J H(p)D,(p;0)p dp
0
+J:-" ~ ( +ppc)ka(p + +
p c ) ~ i ( p pc; o ) ( p + pc) dp - 1 =0
(2.47) f(R) R
:u H ( p ) J , ( R p ) dp
200 FRANS DE MEYER
Applying the trapezoidal rule with interval A to the finite integral (2.43)
yields the weighted sum
(2.48)
where
The form (2.48) can then be converted into the equivalent expression
(2.50)
in which the radii R , have values so that the corresponding circles will pass
through certain grid points. The conversion from (2.48) to (2.50)is made by
applying an n-point interpolation formula to yield an expression for each
f (x,y, r,) in terms of valuesf (x,y, Rk)on the n nearest circles. By combining
the interpolation coefficients with the values of w(rl) one obtains the co-
efficients hk in Eq. (2.50).
An application of this method will be given in Section 3.5 for the process of
the downward continuation of a surface gravity field.
(2.51)
(2.52)
FILTER TECHNIQUES IN GRAVITY INTERPRETATION 201
(2.53)
The form a(x, y) represents the difference between the actual and numerical
outputs
(2.54) Y)= g(x, Y) -m, Y)
From (2.13) and (2.25) it immediately follows that the Fourier transform
of a(z, y) is given by
(2.55) A(u, W) = G(U, V ) -&(U, W ) = F(U, V)[H('U,W) -Hd(u, V ) ]
where Hd(u,w) is one of the forms (2.21) or (2.27). Applying the inverse
Fourier transform to both sides of (2.55)yields
and
where c1 and c2 are constants. According to the basic idea of minimizing the
difference between the true and numerical outputs, the filter coefficients h,
may be determined from the condition
W
(2.61)
1 -03
I~ ( uv),- ~ , ( u w) 1
, du dv = minimum
and
(a/ahj)s'"-VN -UN
[B(u, V)-
k=O
N
hkHRk(U,V )
l2 d u dv = 0
= rr",
from which the weights hk may be computed.
rN H ( u , v)H ra,(u,
w) d u dv, 0 5 j<N
where all the coefficients alk , bj , and ck are known and the xk have t o be
determined. One often deals with the additional condition
(2.70)
with given functions f k ( p ) . For m values p r of the variable p , let the general
formulation of the approximation be
n
(2.71) -
and the task is to find the coefficients hk such that E should be minimum,
without the restriction (2.69). The weighted sum in (2.70)will then provide a
numerical function which approaches g ( p ) in a band of width 2 ~This
. tech-
nique will be used in Section 3.3 for the construction of upward continuation
filters.
AND DOWNWARD
3. UPWARD CONTINUATIONOF THE SURFACE
GRAVITY
EFFECT
with dr' the volume element of the volume v of the earth, r'thepositionvector
of an arbitrary point of the volume v, p(r') the density, Q! the gravitational
constant, and
1 r - r' I = r2 + rI2 - 2rr' cos y
The origin of the orthogonal coordinate system (2, y, z ) is a t the mass center
of the earth, with the z-axis coinciding with the rotation axis; y is the angle
between the directions of r and r',
204 FRANS DE MEYER
At points outside the earth, the integral in Eq. (3.1) is nonsingular and the
gravity potential satisfies Laplace’s equation
whereas for the interior points the integrand in (3.1) becomes singular at
r’ =r; therefore, inside the earth the potential is the solution of Poisson’s
equat,ion
(3.3) VzV(r’) = 4 d p ( r ’ )
The total potential W of the earth consists of two parts, the principal one,
V, caused by the Newton’s attraction, and the other by the earth’s rotation.
If the point P is on the earth’s surface, the gravity vector is defined as the
gradient of the total gravity potential on the surface
(3.4)
whose ajrection is called the vertical in P;the modulus g is known as the
gravitational acceleration or the gravitational field and the unit of g is the
gal = 1 cm/sec2.
Explicitly, the tidal variations in the vector g, in amplitude as well as in
direction, due to the changing positions of the sun and the moon with respect
to the earth are not considered and, therefore, it is assumed that the contri-
butions of the tidal effects to the gravity vector are eliminated from the
measurements, when performing an analysis of an observed surface field.
Indeed, the aim is to study the local deviations of the gravity field in the
earth’s surface, caused by subsurface masses. Consequentlyit will be assumed
that the earth is divided into a regular part, bounded by the earth spheroid,
and a deviation part. The regular part is supposed to have the same mass as
the earth as a whole and the earth spheroid to have the volume and flattening
of the geoid. Clearly it is implicitly assumed that the deviation part of the
earth’s field consists partly of negative masses, so that the total mass of the
deviation part is zero. The potential caused by these deviation masses of the
earth is denoted by U and it is the difference between the total gravity potent-
ial and the potential of the spheroidal earth.
Since the contributions of these local anomalies are inherent in the gravita-
tional field of the earth, a gravimeter can only measure the superimposed
influence of the gravity field of the earth spheroid and of the deviation
masses. The attraction of local anomalous bodies is often seen only rn a
minor distortion of the pattern due to some major structure. The gravimeter,
being leveled in the total gravitational field, can respond only to the vertical
component of the gravity field of the disturbing masses; this is called the
FILTER TECHNIQUES I N GRAVITY INTERPRETATION 205
geneous structure of the upper part of the earth’s crust. For a point P on the
surface we define the gravity effect by
(3.5) Ag(P) = a u ( P ) / a n
where n is the internal normal to the surface.
I n this connection, the assumption has been implicitly made that the direc-
tion of the gravity vector is not disturbed by the presence of these subsurface
masses, as we have supposed that Ag is measured in the direction of normal
<
gravity. The assumption that Ag g is physically justified by the fact that
changes in the densities ofthe crust within the anomalous region will produce
variations in g which will generally not exceed 10 mgal, so that one can say
that the ratio Aglg is of the order of
showing that the distribution of the gravity effect above the earth’s surface is
completely determined by the integration of the surface data. Hence, the
problem of the upward continuation of the gravity effect is reduced to the
numerical integration of Eq. (3.6).
206 FRANS DE MEYER
Equation (3.6) is clearly a convolution integral of the form (2.7) and thus
defines a linear filter, with the surface effect Ag(x, y, 0) as input and as output
the desired field Ag(x, y, z ) a t height z, using a filter function
(3.7) h ( - ) ( x ,Y , Z ) = ( ~ Z ] / ~ TI )/- ( X ~ + ~ ~ + Z ~ ) ~ ’ ~
This intrinsic relation between the problem of upward continuation and the
general linear filter theory was first clearly pointed out by Dean (1958).
I n the frequency plane the equivalent form of Eq. (3.6) becomes
This result can be easily interpreted if one notes that small masses mainly
contribute to the Fourier spectrum of the surface effect in the high frequency
region and that the broader structures induce waves of small frequency.
Combining (3.9) and (3.8) one obtains the fundamental relation
(3.10) +
G(u, v, z ) = exp[ - I z I (uz V ~ ) ~ ’ ~ ] v,
G 0)
(U,
The appearance of the decreasing exponential in Eq. (3.10) implies that the
field will be damped out with increasing height and that the high frequency
part of the Fourier spectrum will be smoothed out faster than the low fre-
quency region. The filter (3.10) clearly has the properties of a low-pass filter,
yet without a sharp cutoff: when the field is represented a t different heights,
first the fine details of local extent, corresponding to small shallow masses,
will disappear, leaving a t last a picture of the regional features of the field.
+
Transforming t o polar coordinates (x - 6) i(y - 7)= rete, Eq. (3.6) can
be written as
EILTER TECHNIQUES IN GRAVITY WTERPRETATION 207
is the average of the surface gravity effect over the circle of radius r, with cen-
ter a t the point (x,y). From Eq. (2.20)i t follows that the integral (3.11) can
be reduced to a weighted sum of the form
(3.13)
11 + 22)3121rdr
N Rk+l
(3.14) &?x, Y, 4 = IzI [A&, y, r ) / ( r 2
k=O Rk
and assumes that the value of Ag(x, y, r ) in the interval (&, R k + l )may be
approximated by the mean of the values a t the end points
w
Adx,y, r , !dAdX,
y, R k ) + y, R k + 1)1
where so is the mesh size of the square grid and m an integer. By expressing
Ag(x, y, r) in terms of polynomials of the second degree over the intervals
( R k , R k + J and using the formula for the gravity anomaly of the sphere,
Henderson arrives a t a weighted sum of the form (3.13)with coefficients shown
in Appendix 1.
Although it must be clearly kept in mind that a suitable numerical inte-
gration method (3.13) has to be a compromise between working with a large
amount of surface data (we ask for a small number of integration coefficients,
in order to reduce the calculation time and the edge effects, imposed by the
square grid of finite extent) and obtaining a sufficient accuracy for the cal-
culated field A ~ Xy,,x ) a t a given height, thisleads to the following conclusions:
208 F U N S DE MEYER
(1) From the point of view of the numerical treatment of the surface data,
both approximations are of the same type as they amount to the computation
of a weighted sum of the form (3.13).
(2) Peters assumes linearity of the surface field over the integration inter-
vals (R,, R,, while Henderson constructs his coefficients using a physical
model, thus allowing for the nonlinear variation of the field over most
integration intervals. This seems to be a reasonable improvement of Peters’
method.
(3) Peters arbitrarily overweights his last coefficient so that the sum of the
coefficients is unity; Henderson’s method does not take this restriction into
account.
(4) Both authors use almost the same number of integration circles, but the
extent of the integration grid is different: R, = d l 2 5 11 units for Peters
and R, = 4 6 2 5 = 26 units for Henderson.
(5) The surface extent of both integration arrays is the same for the con-
tinuations at different heights and only the values of the coefficients change,
whereas, in fact, the extent of the integration grid should be proportional to
the height were one wants to compute the field.
(6) As a final conclusion, the construction of these weighting sequences is
based upon empirical, more or less physically justified assumptions about the
observed surface field; therefore the quantitative success of a given set of
coefficients will directly depend on the degree to which a measured field
meets these assumptions. Hence it would be preferable to constructthe weights
in a more ‘‘ objective ” way, that is on the basis of the mathematical mechan-
ism of the process of the upward continuation of a surface field.
From the above it is evident that the question of the “ best” set of coeffici-
ents for the numerical computation ofthe integral (3.11)is difficult to answer
by the absence of a mathematical norm for the construction of the weights.
Indeed, the accuracy in the upward calculated field will depend more on the
frequency st&cture of the surface field in question than on the use of any
particular weighting sequence. The grid spacing, the number of integration
circles, and the weights, d l empirically chosen, have an important bearing
on the configuration of the h a 1 map.
The differences between the theoretical upward frequency response H ( - )
(u,v, z ) and the discrete frequency characteristicH,(u, v), given by Eq. (2.27),
are shown in Fig. 4 for Peters’ and Henderson’s filters z = 1, .so = 1, h = 1.
Note the direction dependence of H,(u, v ) in the frequency plane, which
implies that the asymmetries in the calculated field at height h are not only
properties of the surface gravity data, but are aIso dependent upon the kind
of Glter one uses. In the low frequency region the deviations are of the order
of 10 yo and we conclude that Peters’ and Henderson’s filters deform sign&-
antly the features that may be ascribed to the larger anomalies of the gravity
FIQ.4. Deviations for (a) Peters’ filter z = 1, so = 1, h = 1 contour interval 4%: (b)
Henderson’s filter z = 1, so = 1 , h = 1, contour interval 4%.
210 FRANS DE MEYER
field. For the higher frequencies one notes Merences of about 15 yo;since
the high frequencies refer to the noise component of the surface field and to
the field of small shallow masses, these effects will be of very local extent in
the h a 1 maps. Nevertheless, they introduce unwanted high frequency ripples
in the smooth output of the upward continuation filter. As a conclusion we
can say that Peters’ and Henderson’s filters are frequency-wisenearly equiva-
lent.
will give the filter weights. For the moment, the discrete frequency response
(2.21)will be used. However, while testing the numerical solution of the linear
system (3.16)it was noted that the accuracy of the approximationwas strongly
dependent on the distribution of the points p j on the frequency axis and, t o a
lesser degree, on the particular choice of the integration grid Rk .
In order to show the instability of the solution of this linear system, the
results are given for the following distribution of the points pr: we divide the
Nyquist interval (0, pN) into two parts of equal length I, = (0, $ p ~ )and
+
I, = (+pN, pN). For N 1 = 20 filter coefficients we place N , equidistant
points in I, and N , = N - N , + 1 equidistant points in I, and let N , vary
from 3 to 12. The root-mean-square differences between the theoretical and
numerical frequency responses thus obtained are shown in Table I for
z = 1, so = 1, h = 1 unit spacing and the integration grid in the first column
of Appendix 2.
TABLE
I
Root-mean-squaredifferences
N1 N2
3 0.026 8 1.016
4 0.032 9 11.944
6 0.023 10 38.817
6 0.107 11 26.390
7 0.264 12 11.660
FILTER TECHNIQUES IN GRAVITY INTERPRETATION 21 1
+
nk/2
afk= (2/nk) cos(Utxjk vi Yj,)t 1 <i m, 1 <k <n
jk=1
As the work is done with a finite weighted sum in Eq. (3.13), the question
of the truncation error resulting from disregarding the field beyond the last
integration circle must be examined. As
(3.17) (1 z 1 /'W Jm
-m
Srn df d ~ / [ (-x 8’ + (Y
-m
- 7)’ + ~ ' 1 =~ 1' ~
one can write for the difference between the true field value at height z and
its value at the surface
(3.18)
m
using Eqs. (3.11) and (3.12).Now, applying the numerical integration method
as in Eq. (3.13) to the right-hand side of (3.18) one obtains
or
Let the circle of radius R represent the area taken into accountin the numer-
ical integration of the right-hand side of Eq. (3.18).Then it follows that the
true field at height z may be written as
+ I I 1 [Adx, Y,r)/(r"+
m
Adz, Y,4 -N &k
-
(3.20) Y,2 ) z2)312174dr
Whether or not the sum of the filter coefficients should be made equal to
unity depends entirely upon personal judgment. However, if one requires
that the weights add up to unity, it is found to result in relatively large values
of E in the method of h e a r programming and it was difficult t o reduce the
value of this E . On the other hand, not taking this restriction into account
one obtains a faster convergence to an acceptable solution, with a minor loss
of accuracy (rounding-off errors) and in addition small values of E . I n con-
sequence preference is given to the second alternative.
The significance of this E must be kept clearly in mind: in the method of
least-squares, E means the root-mean-square differencebetween the theoretical
and numerical frequency responses, while in the method of linear program-
ming E stands for the maximum difference between both curves. Therefore,
one can compare the following results:
+
z = 1, a0 = 1, h = 1, N 3 = 20, R, = 4100, least-squares: E = 1.7 yo,
maximum difference 5.5%,
+
z = 1, so = 1, h = 1, N I = 20, R, = 4 1 0 0 , linear programming: E =
3.5 yo,maximum difference 3.5 yo.
Hence, we have constructed a discrete filter, simulating the process of
upward continuation, giving an approximation to the theoretical filter
H ( - ) ( u ,v, z ) for z = 1, with an accuracy of 3.5 yo over the Nyquist domain
of the frequency plane.
The reduction of the integration grid with R, = 4 2 7 4 16.5 units t o
a grid with R, = dl00 = 10 units results in a small increase in the value of
E : from 1.3 yo to 1.7 yo in the method of least-squares and from 3.2 yo to
3.5 % for the method of linear programming. This is an interesting result
since a limited integration grid enables us to reduce considerably the deforma-
tion of the field near the edges of the surface grid on which the field is known.
The considerable gain of this method must be found in the generality of its
principles: the coefficients are derived from the knowledge of the frequency
response function, describing the mathematical mechanism of the upward
continuation of a surface field in the frequency plane. The method does not use
any empirical assumption about the field, as was the case with Peters’ and
Henderson’s filters. Also the flexibility of the method of linear programming
in these approximation techniques is remarkable: the construction of the
weights h, is practically independent of the choice of the distribution of the
frequency points (u,, VJ, because one can take rn several times larger than n.
x I:m
Srn Ad[, 7,z)/[(x t)'+ (Y
-w
- - 7)’ +z ' I ~ ' d~ t dq, >0
This hypothesis leads to an inevitable divergence in the mathematical
expressions, describing the downward continuation process, because the
earth's surface is a real discontinuity plane and anomalous masses do occur
between the two levels.
The expression (3.21) is an integral equation for the field a t depth z ; with
the same notations as in Eq. (3.8) and applying the convolution theorem
of Fourier transforms we obtain
(3.22) G(u, V , 0) = H'-'(u, V , z)G(u, V , X )
FILTER TECHNIQUES I GRAVITY INTERPRETATION 215
factory than Peters’ algorithm. On the other hand, the frequency decay is
sharper in Peters’ method and Henderson’s coefficients more greatly amplify
the high frequency waves in the input field, so that we may expect larger
fluctuations in the projected field than with Peters’ weights. The conclusion is
obvious: we need to construct a filter somewhere between these two methods,
that is, a filter matching H ( + ) ( uv,, z ) very closely in the low frequency range
and cutting off rather sharply.
FILTER TECHNIQUES IN GRAVITY INTERPRETATION 217
also satisfies (3.26), where A may be taken arbitrarily large provided that
+ --
pla - +pnZi s also sufficiently large. Therefore $ is not determined con-
tinuously from measurements of q ~ ,because rapidly oscillating $ produce a
small q ~ .I n our case of gravitational interpretation this means that itisalways
possible to add t o any solution Ag(x, y, z ) a harmonic mass distribution of
arbitrarily great amplitude provided that the frequencies, induced by the
added distribution, are sufficiently large. Therefore the observations a t the
earth’s surface can give no information about changes in density occurring in a
horizontal distance small compared with the depth, and the solution required
is one that does not contain these rapid oscillations.
Accordingly one has t o look for partial information about # which is in-
sensitive to rapid oscillations in $. For this reason Kreisel defines the smoothed
version a€$
(3.28)
Applying this theorem t o the integral equation (3.21) we define the smoothed
version of the field a t depth z by
with
(3.33) h(+)(z,
y, z) = (1/4ra) 1 m
-m
m
f
-m
, z)W(u,v)ei(ur+uy)dzl
H ( + ) ( uv, dw
belongs to the class L,. Only in the case where the smoothing function w(x, y)
fulfils this condition can we apply Kreisel's theorem, in order to find a solution
FILTER TECHNIQUES IN’ GRAVITY INTERPRETATION 219
of the inverse potential problem, not for the field a t depth z itself, but for the
components of the field which are not eliminated from the Fourier spectrum
of the surface field by the frequency response W ( u ,w).
J:-” +
0
Using the results in Eqs. (2.48)and (2.49)one finally obtains the following
weighted sum for the smoothed field at depth z
- N
(3.45) Ag(x, ?/,2) 2: hk Adz, Rk)
k=O
with weights hk .
There is a problem in defining the parameters pc , pk , and a. The choice of
pk and a is rather arbitrary and depends upon the kernel one decides to use.
If ka(p) is a FBjer kernel, then one can define pk as the first zero of k,(p) and we
obtain the relation
(3.46) - pk) == 7T
If k,(p) is a Weierstrass kernel, then one defines Pk as the freqwlicy where the
frequency response R j + ) ( p ,z ) is equal t o a small number 6
I I 3 4
(a1
, ......... I...
I
. . _ . . I. . . . . . . . . . I . . . . . . . . .I . . . . . f
2 3 4
I . . . . . . . . . I.......-.L..,.,
I
. . . .I . . . . . . . . . l . . . . . P . . .
2 3 4
(C) (dl
FIG.8. Frequency response corresponding to (a) Test (1); (b) Test (2); (c) Test (3);
(d) Test (4).
with
and
(3.53) bm+j=O, 1<j<n
Further one can demand that the sum of the coefficients should differ
slightly from unity, adding to the system (3.48) the condition
(3.54)
or
n
(3.55) ~ a m + n + l , k x k - b m + n + l ~ E
k=l
with
(3.56) am+n+i,k=p, 1Sk<n
bm+n+1 =B
Finally it is possible t o introduce approximation degrees over the Nyquist
interval. Indeed, suppose that we divide the interval J = (1 j <m> into
subintervals J , =(rnf< j< m,+ 1}, 1 < i 2 s, m, = 1, and m,,, = m. If
FILTER TECHNIQUES IN GRAVITY INTERPRETATION 225
we now want to obtain the accuracies elat in the intervals J i then we can
write the system
(3.57) -
if we define
(3.58) a;k= a , a j k ,h,’ = a , h , , 1 < i <s, 1 5 k < n
mt< j<W*+l
Among the several filters obtained with this method, are the weights
given in Appendix 6, for the following choice of parameters:
Test (1): z = 1, pc = 1, N = 13 filter weights, Weierstrass kernel with
pic= 2 and ci = 6.61, y1 = 14, /3 = 4.
Test (2): z = 1, pc = 1, N = 13 filter weights, Weierstrass kernel with
pk = 2 and u = 6.61, y1 = 14, = 4, and approximation degrees
;E in the interval 0 pc pk
58 in the interval pc < p 2 pk
e in the interval Pk < p
The corresponding frequency responses are illustrated in Fig. 9.
The curve corresponding to Test (1) shows that the maximum deviation
from the modified downward continuation frequency response is about 14.4 yo
in the low frequency range of the Nyquist interval. The Test (2) yields a
value for E of about 10.7y0, which must be interpreted as follows: in the low
frequency range 0 < p < pc we have an approximation of about $ E = 5.3 yo
1 3 4
(01 (bl
and in the high frequency range p > p k the oscillations of the frequency
response have amplitudes of E = 10.7 yo.Since the introduction of the kernel
k,(p) enables us t o avoid the sharp cutoff a t the point p c , it is immaterial
what the accuracy of the approximation will be in the interval pG < p < pk .
As a final conclusion we can state that the method of linear programming
yields coefficients, simulating sufficiently the modified downward continua-
tion process, and constructs discrete filters which are d e h e d as a function
of the observed surface field. The only parameter t o be estimated is the cutoff
frequency p c , that is the point where we want the frequency response t o
become essentially zero. This technique enables us t o derive filters as functions
of the Fourier spectrum of the surface effect, in opposition to the methods of
Peters and Henderson. I n contrast with the upward continuation, which
defines a stable filter, it is now desirable to separate the input field into signal
and noise components. For this reason we remark that the coefficientsobtained
are only indicative, but the method is general enough to compute readily
numerical filters, once the cutoff frequency is estimated.
4. FREQUENCY FILTERING
Here it is assumed that all the fields considered have zero mean values; if
this is not true for an observed field, we suppose that the arithmetical mean is
substracted from the field values.
Note how naturally correlation functions arise in this type of problem. It
must be said, however, that the validity of the expression (4.6)as the definition
of the expected value of a field g(x, y) rests on two assumptions: the first is
the hypothesis of ergodicity, stating that the required statistical information
about the stochastic process, of which g(x, y) is a specific sample function,
may be extracted from one typical realization of the random process. The
second assumption is the hypothesis of stationarity of the field g(x, y).
implying that the statistical quantities are independent of the particular
choice of the origin in the coordinate plane. As a result of these assumptions
we conclude that all statistical properties of the processes in question may be
evaluated by appropriate integrals over the (5, y)-plane, thus avoiding the
necessity of defining them by ensemble averages over the realizations of the
stochastic process.
The form (4.7)gives the mean-square system error for a particular filter,
as specified by its weighting function h(x, y). The quantity E{eh2)is now min-
imized as a function of the filter function h(x, y), in order to find that linear
filter hopt(z,y), giving the least possible mean-square system error. The
existence and uniqueness of this optimum filter are tacitly assumed, but will
be usually guaranteed from the physical presentation of the problem.
It may be shown (Bendat, 1958) that, a necessary and sufficient condition
that hopt(x.y) be the filter function of the optimal filter, given by the minimal-
ization of the mean-square system error (4.7), is that it is the solution of
the Wiener-Hopf integral equation
I n the case of gravity interpretation let us define the filter input to be the
surface field Ag(x, y, 0) and then assume that it consists of a signal component
s(x, y) and an additive noise n(x, y)
(4.13) f , ( X , Y ) = 4x9 Y)
According to Eq. (4.10) the optimal impulse response hopt(x,y) of the linear
filter that passes s(x, y) and rejects n(x, y) satisfies the Wiener-Hopf equation
where Ago is a shorthand notation for the surface gravity effect, yago(x,y) is
the autocovariance of the surface field, and yAgo,s(x, y) is the covariance
between the input field and the signal component.
Applying the convolution theorem of Fourier transforms, the optimal
frequency response HOpt(u,w) follows directly from Eq. (4.14)
(4.16) PAg0(u,V ) = 1
m
-m
m
-m
u ~dy
yAgo(x,y ) e - i ( U z +d~ )
and Pdgo, s(u,v) is the cross-power spectrum between Ag(x, y, 0) and s(x, y),
that is the Fourier transform of yAgo. s(x,y).
The minimum mean-square system error may be expressed in terms of
power spectra. With the definition of the function
m m
(4*17) x(xt y) = Y S ( ~y)
, -
-m -m
hopt(c, 7)YAgo. - 5,!/ - 7)d6 dq
i t is easy to see that
(4.18)
Ysn(x, Y) = 0,
that is,
P s n ( u ,w) = 0 for any x , y, u, w,
we then have that
(4.21) YAgo(”? Y) = Ys(u, v, + Yn(u, w,
or in terms of frequency
(4.22) pAgo(u? v, = p s ( u , v, + Pn(u, v,
We also find that
Combining (4.22), (4.23), and (4.15) one finally obtains for the optimal
frequency response
(4.24) Hopt(w v) = PA% v)/[Ps(u,
v) + Pn(u, 41
and the minimum mean-square system error is given by (4.19)
(4.25)
E { ~ ; ~ ~(1/4n2)
J = Jm
-m
Sm--m
ps(U, + pn(u,
v ) p n ( u , v ) / [ ~ s ( v)
u, V)I . du dv
Now we define the modified downward continuation process by calculating
the downward projected field of the signal component of the surface field.
Hence, the field a t a desired depth will be the output of two linear filters in
series: the first filter extracts the signal component optimally from the input
field, and the second filter amplifies the signal part toward its source,
according to the theoretical filter H ( + ) ( u ,v, 2). This is just the procedure
already mentioned in Eq. (3.35), where now the frequency response W ( u ,w) is
replaced by the optimum frequency characteristic Hopt(u,w) of the Wiener
filter.
232 FRANS DE MEYER
Suppose that fi(x, y) is the input to a first filter with filter function h,(s, y);
the outputf,’(x, y) of this filter serves as input to a second filter with weighting
function h,(x, y). Then it is easy t o see that the filter function of the compound
filter is the convolution of both weighting functions
whence
(4.27) H(% 9) = HI(%,vfH,(%,4
Indeed, according to Eq. (2.7),the output of the compound filter is
and
(4.32)
(4.33) E{n}= 0
and autocovariance
(4.34) m(5, 7) = E{n(x, Y)n(x+ 4, Y + 7))
The physical origin of the noise is immaterial; unfortunately, the statistical
characteristics of the noise are not known beforehand and this is a serious
disadvantage of Wiener's method. This difficulty is partially overcome by
Strakhov's method (1964, a, b), reviewed by Naidu (1966, 1967).
Suppose that the observed values in (4.30) are smoothed by a linear filter
with weights hk,, -M < k M , - N < I < N ; then one can write for the
output of this filter
(4.36)
and
(4.37)
the smoothed versions of the signal and the noise; Ax and Ay stand for the
grid spacings in the x- and y-directions, respectively.
The mean of the filtered noise is zero, since
(4.38)
FILTER TECHNIQUES IN GRAVITY INTERPRETATION 235
We attempt t o determine the filter coefficients h,, such that (1) the dis-
torted signal B(z, y) is as close to ~ ( 2y), as possible (in some metric), and
(2) the variance us;of the random process, of which ii(x, y) is a realization, is
as small as possible.
The distortion of the signal caused by the linear operator h,, may be esti-
mated by the &-metric. Using Parseval's theorem for double Fourier trans-
forms, we obtain
where X(zc, v) and 8(u, v) are the Fourier transforms of s(x, y) and 9(z, y),
respectively. From (4.36)it immediately follows that
(4.41) B(u,8 ) = H ( u , v)S(u,v)
where H(u, v) is the frequency response of the discrete filter h,, ,
Polya (1929) shows that every potential field signal has a unique smallest
convex region containing all singularities of the potential field. If we let d
stand for the depth of the uppermost singularity we have the following
inequality
(4.44) I Q(u,v, 011 I
(1/2r)llAg(x,y, d - E ) I I L ~exp[-(d - &)(u2+ +')1'21
where E is a small, positive number. We also note that lJAg(s,y, d - &)/IL1 is
a constant and may be interpreted as the total excess mass within the
anomalous region. Introducing Polya's inequality into (4.43)results in
s, I,
m m
(4.46) Srn I
-m
m
-m
exp[-2d(u2 + va)1/2][1 - H ( u , v)], du dv = minimum
236 FRANS DE MEYER
“he simple minimization of the form (4.46)is not sufficient, as the filter co-
efficients could then be easily determined from the condition that H ( u , v ) = 1
over the frequency plane. Indeed, the condition that the variance of the
reduced noise be small must still be satisfied. Equation (4.39)readily gives for
the variance of the reduced noise
Dividing both sides of this expression by the variance yn(O,0) of the noise
n(x, y) it follows that
(4.48)
and this has been called the “prescribed noise reduction factor” by Naidu
(1967).
In practice it is impossible to estimate the autocovariance of the noise with
a sufficient accuracy; therefore, all the terms in Eq. (4.47),except the fist,
are indefinite. Strakhov’s method consists of minimizing the form (4.46),
with the condition that the noise should be reduced by a prescribed factor h2.
The remaining terms in Eq. (4.47)may then be interpreted as correction
factors t o be applied to this prescribed noise reduction factor for a given
statistical structure of the noise n(x, y). The filter coefficients h,, can be
found from the conditions (4.46)and (4.48)by a modification of the method
of steepest descent; a computer program in FORTRAN I1 language can be
found in the paper by Naidu (1967).The single parameter to be estimated
from the surface field is the depth d of the uppermost singularity of the poten-
tial field.
It is interesting that Strakhov’s method does not explicitly require know-
ledge of the statistical properties of the signal, neither of the noise. However,
Naidu’s introduction of a prescribed noise reduction factor is based upon a
white noise assumption, and this is very similar t o what has been said about
Wiener’s method. I n Strakhov’s method the signal distortion and variance
FILTER TECHNIQUES W GRAVITY INTERPRETATION 237
of the noise are minimized separately, while in Wiener's method the sum of
signal distortion and random noise is minimized. Wiener's method has the
advantage that the filtering is performed entirely in the frequency plane;
the method of Strakhov f i s t supplies the filter coefficients, which yield a
smooth output of the surface field by discrete convolution, and then this
filtered signal may be transformed to the frequency plane. It is difficult to
say which method is superior; the choice is left to the interpreter.
1 5 k < rn, 1 < 1 < n, where S(x, y) is the infinite Dirac comb in two dimen-
sions (Blackman and Tukey, 1958, p. 71)
m w
(4.50) 6 ( ~y), = A X Ay 1 C
a= - r = -
w m
S(S - q Ax) S(y - T Ay)
and
(4.51) do( x,y) = 1, A x < x < rn Ax, Ay< y < n Ay
= 0, otherwise
P J u , v) = C C
k=-m I=-m
f (k Ax, 1 Ay)exp[ - i(u kAx + vl Ay)] Ax Ay
238 FRANS DE MEYER
Using the convolution theorem for Fourier transforms, this expression becomes
(4.52) Fa(u,W ) = D,(u, V) * V ( UV), * F(u, V)
where * denotes convolution and D,(u, v), V ( u ,v), and F(u,w ) are the Fourier
transforms of do@, y), 6(z, y), and f(z, y), respectively. Since the Fourier
transform of the infinite Dirac comb 6(x, y) is an infinite Dirac comb in
frequency
m
(4.53) V(u,v) = 1
q z -m r= -m
6(u - (2nqlAx)) 6(w - (2~rrlAy))
with
(4.55) D,(u, v) = 4mn Ax Ay(sin nu Ax/nu Ax)(sin mVAy/mv Ay)
The expression (4.54) must be interpreted as follows: suppose that the
sampled version off(z, y) is available all over the (5, y)-plane. Then Eq. (4.49)
becomes
I f the sampling rates Ax and Ay are so chosen that f (x, y) contains no waves
of frequencies outside the Nyquist domain
(4.57) --n/Ax u n/Ax, -n/Ay Iv < r / A y
then it is completely determined by giving its ordinates a t the grid points.
As no information about f (2, y) is available between the grid points, there is
no means of directly estimating the amplitudes of frequencies outside the
Nyquist domain. I n other words, Eq. (4.56)shows that the sampled Fourier
spectrum Pa(u,w ) is obtained by folding the true Fourier spectrum F(u, v)
FILTER TECHNIQUES IN GRAVITY INTERPRETATION 239
into the Nyquist domain and adding these contributions inside the low frequ-
ency region. This spectrum distortion has been called “aliasing” by J. W.
Tukey. If f(x, y) has the property that its Fourier transform F(u,v) is
essentially zero outside the Nyquist domain, then the terms for q # 0 and
r f O in (4.56) do not contribute to the sampled Fourier spectrum and the
digitization process loses no information. Since the Nyquist frequencies
uN = rlAx and vN = n1Ay are controlled by the grid spacings, we conclude
that the practical application of the concept of the sampled Fourier spectrum
consists of choosing grid spacings that are small enough to reduce the aliasing
to an acceptable level.
Furthermore we note from Eq. (4.64)that iff(x, y) is sampled on a rect-
angular grid of finite dimensions, then the aliased Fourier spectrum Fa(u,v)
will be the convolution of the sampled Fourier spectrum P,(u, w) with the
Fourier transform D,(u, v) of the function d,(x, y), thus introducing a second
kind of frequency distortion. Even if aliasing were absent, the true Fourier
spectrum F(u,v) would be blurred out by the frequency kernel D,(u,v).
The power spectrum may be treated in a completely analogous way.
Indeed, the best one can obtain from the sampled field is the knowledge of
the ‘‘ aliased )’ autocovariance
(4.58) ya(k AX,2 AY)=[ddx, Y) &x, Y)Y(X, ~)lz=rcAz
Y = IAY
where y ( x ,y) is the true autocovariance off (x,y). It immediately follows that
the sampled, finite version of the power spectrum P(u,v) is given by
In complete analogy with Eq. (4.59) the aliased, finite power spectrum is
given by the convolution
and using the fact that 6(x - xo) and e - * " + O are Fourier transform pairs,
together with the trigonometric relation
m
(4.64)
k=O
cos ku = cos )(m + l ) u sin imulsin ?p
we find that
(4.65) v) = A x A y cotg t u A x cots +v A y sin nu A x sin mu Ay
Vmn(u,
Hence, the aliased power spectrum may also be regarded as the convolution
v).
of the true power spectrum with the aliased kernel Vmn(u,
When writing Eq.(4.58) it was explicitly mentioned that the best one could
obtain from the sampled field f (k Ax, 1 Ay), 1 k <m, 1 I n, are the<<
values y ( k Ax, I Ay), - m +
1 < k < m - 1, - n +
1 < I < n - 1 ofthe true
autocovariancey(x, y) of the surface field as a whole. This surely is an optimi-
stic statement. Indeed, the indirect method of power spectrum estimation
starta with the computation of the following estimator of the autocovariance
(4.66)
OIlLn-1
where it is assumed that the mean of the surface field is zero.Parzen (1957a)
advocates the use of the estimator
FILTER TECHNIQUES IN QRAVITY WTERPRETATION 241
€or any finite m and n, but fo(k, I) is biased for finite m and n and asymptoti-
cally unbiased, since
(4.69) E{fdk, 4 ) = hm(k)hn(l)y(k,1)
with
hm(k)=l-(lkl/~), -m+l<k<m-l
(4.70)
= 0, Ik( > r n - 1
Bias, however, is not the only, and certainly not the most important criterion
for a "good" estimate and a preference for the biased estimate fo(k, 1) is
sometimes voiced on the grounds that i t has, in general, smaller mean-square
error than the unbiased estimate jjo(k, 1) (Parzen, 1957b).
These estimates are computable for values of k and 1 up to 1 k 1 = m - 1
and I1 I = n - 1, but jjo(m- 1, n - 1)is then estimated by the single product
f(1, l)f(m, n). Hence we cannot estimate y(k, 1) beyond Ikl = m - 1 ,
12 I = n - 1. It was empirically observed by M. G. Kendall that the sample
autocovariances fail t o damp down to zero for increasing values of k and 1
(rn and n), although the true autocovariance does damp down to zero €or
x + 03 and y + 03. To avoid the discontinuity of the estimates a t the end
points, one introduces a n even function d(k, Z), called a covariance kernel (or
covariance window), and subject to the restrictions that d(0, 0) = 1 and
d(k,Z)=Ofor I k ] > m ' - l a n d 111 > n ' - l , w h e r e m ' < m a n d n ' < n a r e
integers. The modified autocovariance estimates are then defined by
jje(k, I ) = d(k, l)vo(k, 11, fe(k9 1 ) =d(k, Z)fo(k, 1)
(4.71)
-m' + 1< k I m ' - 1, -n' + 1st I n ' - 1
and i t is interesting to see that jje(k, I) and fe(k, I) are defined for all k and 1
and vanish for I kl >m' - 1 and 121 > n' - 1, although the estimates
jjo(k, I) and f,(k, I) are not defined there.
I n consequence, the modified power spectrum is defhed by
(4.72)
or
(4.73)
242 FRAXS DE MEYER
It may be shown that these estimates of the power spectrum are asympto-
tically unbiased since, for example, the expected value of PJu, w) is given by
(4.74) E{P,(u, w)} = D(u, W ) * D,(u, V ) * V ( u ,V ) * P(u, W )
where D(u, v) is the Fourier transform of d ( k , I ) , and D,(u, v) and V ( u ,v)
are given by Eqs. (4.55) and (4.63), respectively.
Because the variance of Pe(u,w) is approximately given by
1 1
(4.75) variP,(u, v)) 21 (m‘/m)(n’/n)Pz((u,w) J”
-1
J -1
~ ( sy),dx dy
(4.76)
(4.77) Pmn(u,w) =
m-1
c
k = -m+l
n-1
1 X,(k)h,(Z)~,(k, Z)e-t(ku+iu)
I= -n+l
or
(4.78) E{Pmn(u,w)) = Sn sn
-n -n
A,,(u - u ,u - v’)P(u’, v’) du’ dw
with Amn(u,u) the two-dimensional Fhjer kernel, associated with the periodo-
gram estimate of P(u, w)
(4.79) Amn(u,v) = (l/rnn)(sin&mu/sin&)“sin +nw/sin + w ) ~
The expected value of Pmn(u,w) is not P(u, v), but a weighted integral of
the power spectrum and, therefore one has to conclude that the periodogram
is a biased estimate of the density spectrum of the continuous field for finite
FILTER TECHNIQUES IN GRAVITY INTERPRETATION 243
(4.81)
where the coefficients W(h,p ) are the weights of a suitable filter. It may be
shown that the expected value of the smoothed periodogram will be given by
P q
(4.82) lim E{P,,,,(r, 8 ) ) N P(2vr/m, 2mln)
m- m
1 1
A= - p fl= - q
W(h,p)
n- m
This relation produces the criterion by which the filter coefficients should add
up to unity, in order to obtain an asymptotically unbiased estimate of the
density spectrum.
The variance of the smoothed periodogram is given to a good approxima-
tion by
- p fi= - 4
n- m
and one sees that the variance of the unsmoothed periodogram will be de-
creased by a factor
(4.84)
(3) The main problem of frequency filtering is evidently concerned with the
fact that we work with a Fourier series of discrete data and the relation with
the true Fourier transform is always problematic, as shown in Section 4.4.
The practical computations of power spectra also impose several restrictions.
I n consequence it is not uncommon to observe distortion in the size and shape
of the anomalies of the transformed field. These deviations evidently arise
from the fundamental fact that the Fourier series is an incomplete approxi-
mation t o the exact Fourier transform of the field as a whole. I n this con-
nection the importance of the problem of aliasing must be recognized: if the
grid spacings are so chosen that the Fourier spectrum contains appreciable
power above the Nyquist frequencies, then we may expect that the calculated
spectra may differ considerably from the true spectra at low frequencies,
that is in the region where the frequency contributions of the broader anom-
alies are situated.
Considering these deficiencies of both methods i t is difficult to decide which
procedure should give the most reliable results. It is true that convolution
filtering is more time consuming, but frequency filtering supposes knowledge
of the desired output and involves individually designed filters for each
problem. A choice between both methods may be voiced on the grounds of
practical considerations regarding computer time and storage. Until the
advent of fast Fourier transform techniques, filtering in the frequency plane
demanded excessive computing time as compared with convolution. This
leads to a brief examination of the mechanics of Cooley-Tukey's method
(1965).
The discrete Fourier transform of a one-dimensional sample function f (k),
0 5 k 5 m - 1, is defined by
m-1
(4.89) F ( r )= C f (k)e-zn*kr/m, O r m -1
k=o
To solve for F ( r ) one would normally select a value for r and perform the
summation over k. Suppose now that m is factorable and that it may be ex-
pressed as
(4.90) m = mlmz
and the inner sum over k, depends only on r o ; therefore one can define a new
array
(4.92)
(4.93)
(4.94)
5. CALCULATIONOF DERIVATIVES
OF HIGHER
ORDER
In the last twenty-five years much effort has been devoted to improving the
methods of calculation of derivatives of higher order of a surface field,
derivable from the gravity potential. The second vertical derivative in
particular is a very interesting aid in the interpretation of local features.
Because the anomalous gravity effect Ag(x, y, z ) satisfiesthe Laplace equation,
the following relation between the vertical second derivative and the two
horizontal derivatives in the directions x and y exists
m
v, du dv
(6.3) Sm
(an1a.q Ag(x, y, 2) = (1/4~2)- m -m
zt, o)(u2+ V
a(%, 2 y
+
x exp[z(ua v2)1/2]ei(ut+uY)du dv
FILTER TECHNIQUES IN GRAVITY INTERPRETATION 249
Writing G ( n ) ( v,
~ ,0) for the Fourier transform of the vertical derivative of
order n a t the surface we have the following frequency relation
(5.5) G(")(u,W, 0) = (uZ+ v')~/'G(u,V , 0)
Hence, the vertical derivative of order n defines a linear filter on the surface
gravity effect with frequency response
APPENDIX1.
PETERS’
AND HENDERSON’S
FILTERS
FOR UPWARD
CONTINUATION
Peters Henderson
Rk
h=l h=2 h=l h=2 h=3 h=4 h=5
APPENDIX2.
COEFFICIENTS
FOR THE CONTINUATION,
UPWARD h =1
APPENDIX3.
PETERS’ AND HENDERSON’S
FILTERS
FOR THE DOWNWARD
CONTINUATION
Peters Henderson
APPENDIX
4.
FILTERS
GRANT-WEST FOR DOWNWARD
CONTINUATION
2 = 0.75
Rk
y = 119 y = 1/6 y = 1/6 y = lj4 y = 1/4 y = lj3
APPENDIX5.
FOR TEE DOWNWARD
COEFFICIENTS d = 1, APPROXIMATION
CONTINUATION v)-
IN THE (u,
PLANE
6.
APPENDIX
CONTINUATIONd
COEFFICIENTSFOR TEE DOWNWARD PROGIRAMMINQ
= 1, LINEAR
METHOD
0.48901 0.47795
0.66810 0.87574
1.46550 1.32928
-0.21308 0.02968
1.09735 0.40451
-2.00891 - 1.49369
-0.52898 -0.71446
0.71144 0.44360
- 2.00891 - 1.49369
1.00588 1.11425
-0.34729 0.10756
1.21442 0.68057
-0.50866 -0.67464
1.03587 1.02668
0.1435 0.1067
ACKNOWLEDGMENTS
The author acknowledges his indebtednessto Prof. A. De Vuyst, whose encouragement
and interest were a constant stimulation t o accomplish this work;to Prof. J. van Isacker
for offering helpful suggestions and for the use of the computer a t the Royal Meteoro-
logical Institute; and to Prof. J. van Mieghem for presenting the manuscript.
LISTOF SYMBOLS
d,(.r) Covariance kernel
-
A d z , Y, Calculated field a t
4
6(z, y) Infinite Dirac comb depth z
a,,@, y) Finite Dirac comb 9 Linear filter operator
V(u,u) Fourier transform of f (x, Y) General two-dimen-
infinite Dirac comb sional function
Vmn(u,u ) Fourier transform of qu,v ) Fourier transform of
Gnite Dirac comb f (29Y)
A d z , y, 4 Average of Ag(x, Y. 0) f’@, Y) Input to linear filter
over the circle of fO(% Y) Output of linear fitter
radius r Y) Desired output of Wie-
Ag(x,y,z) Gravity effect a t the
- level z
Ag(z, y, z ) Calculated field at
Fa(%
ner filter
4 Fourier transform of
sampled field
height z 0 Gravitational constant
FILTER TECHNIQUES IN GRAVITY INTERPRETATION 255
REFERENCES
A. General worka
Anderson, T. W. (1971). “The Statistical Analysis of Time Series.” Wiley, New York.
Arsac, J. (1961). “Transformation de Fourier et th6orie des distributions.” Dunod,
France.
Bartlett, M. S. (1962). An Introduction t o Stochastic Processes.” Cambridge Univ.
Press, London and New York.
Bendat, J. S. (1968). “Principles and Applications of Random Noise Theory.” Wiley,
New York.
Blaokman, R. B., and Tukey, J. W. (1968). “The Measurement of Power Spectra.”
Dover, New York.
Courant, R., and Hilbert, D. (1962). “Methods of Mathematical Physics.” Wiley,
New York.
Dantzig, G. B. (1963). Linear Programming and Extensions.” Princeton Univ. Press,
Prinoeton, New Jersey.
Dobrin, M. B. (1960). “Introduction to Geophysical Prospecting.” McGraw-Hill, New
York.
Doob, J. L. (1968). “Stochastic Processes.” Wiley, New York.
Garland, G. D. (1966). “The Earth’s Shape and Gravity.” Pergamon, Oxford.
Grant, F. S., and West, G. F. (1965). “Interpretation Theory in Applied Geophysics.”
McGraw-Hill, New York.
Grenander, U., and Rosenblatt, M. (1957). “Statistical Analysis of Stationary Time
Series.” Wiley, New York.
Hannan, E. J. (1960). “Time Series Analysis.” Wiley, New York.
Heiskanen, W. A., and Meinesz, F. A. (1968). “The Earth and its Gravity Field.”
McGraw-Hill, New York.
Holloway, J. L. (1968). “ Smoothing and filtering of time series and space fields. Advan
aeophya. 4,361-389.
Kellog, 0. D. (1900). “Foundations of Potential Theory.” Dover, New York.
Kopal, 2. (1961). “Numerical Analysis.” Chapman & Hall, London.
Lee, Y. W. (1960). “Statistical Theory of Communioations ” Wiley, New York.
Morse, P. M., and Feshbaoh, H. (1953). “Methods of Theoretical Physics.” McGraw-Hill,
New York.
Papoulis, A. (1965). “ Probability, Random Variables and Stochastic Processes.”
McGraw-Hill, New York.
Rice, J. R. (1964). “The Approximation of Functions.” Addison-Wesley, Reading,
Massachusetts.
Sneddon, I. N. (1961). “Fourier Transforms.” McGraw-Hill, New York.
Todd, J. (1962). “Survey of Numerical Analysis.” McGraw-Hill, New York.
Van Trees, H. L. (1968). “Detection, Estimation and Modulation Theory.” Wiley,
New York.
Watson, G. N. (1968). “A Treatise on the Theory of Bessel Functions.” Cambridge
Univ. Press, London and New York.
Wiener, N. (1960). “ Extrapolation, Interpolation and Smoothing of Stationary Time
Series.” Wiley, New York.
B. Upward continuation
Henderson, R. G. (1960). A comprehensive system of automatic computation in magnetic
and gravity interpretation. Geophyaica 23, 669-686.
FILTER TECHNIQUES W GRAVITY INTERPRETATION 257
Henderson, R. G., and Zietz, I. (1949). The upward continuation of anomalies in total
magnetic intensity fields. Geophysics 14, 51 7-534.
Nettleton, L. L., and Cannon, J. R. (1962). Investigation of upward continuation
systems. Geophysics 27, 796-806.
Peters, L. J. (1949). The direct approach to magnetic interpretation and its practical
application. Geophysics 14, 290-320.
C. Downward eontinuation
Bullard, E. C., and Cooper, R. I. B. (1948). Determination of the masses necessary t o
produce a given gravitational field. Proc. Roy. SOC.,Ser. A 194, 332-347.
Ku, C. C., Telford, W. M., and Lim, S. H. (1971). The use of linear filtering in gravity
problems. Geophysics 36, 1174-1203.
Nedelkov, I. P., and Burnev, P. H. (1962). Determination of gravitational fields in
depth. Geophys. Prospect. 10, 1-18.
Negi, J. G. (1967). Convergence and divergence in downward continuation. Geophysics
32,867-871.
Roy, A. (1966). Downward continuation and its application to electromagnetic data
interpretation. Geophysics 31, 167-184.
Roy, A. (1967). Convergence in downward continuation for some simple geometries.
Geophysics 32, 853-866.
Rudman, A. J., Mead, J.,Whaley, J. F., and Blakely, R. F. (1971). Geophysical analysis
in central Indiana using potential field continuation. Geophysics 36, 878-890.
Trejo, C. A. (1954). A note on downward continuation of gravity. Geophysics 19, 71-75.
Mesk6, A. (1966).Some notes concerning the frequency analysis for gravity interpretation.
Qeophyd. Prospect. 13,476-488.
Mufti, I. Ic. (1972).Design of small operators for the continuation of potential field data.
aeophy& 37,488-606.
Naidu, P. S. (1966).Extraction of potential field signal from a background of random
noise by Strakhov’s method. J. aeophys. Res. 71, 6987-6996.
Naidu, P. S. (1967).Two dimensional Strakhov’s filter for extraction of potential field
signal. aeophys. P r o 8 p d . 15, 135-160.
Strakhov, V. N. (1964s). The smoothing of observed strengths of potential fields.
Part I. Bull. A d . Sci. USSR, Geophys. Ser. 10, 897-904.
Strakhov, V.N. (1964b).The smoothing of observed strengths of potential fields. Part 11.
Bull. Acad. SCi., USSR, 0eophy8. Ser. 11, 986-996.
Swartz, C. A. (1963).Some geometricalproperties of residual maps. Geophy&m 19,46-70.
Swartz, C. A. (1954).Filtering associated with selective sampling of geophysical data.
Geophysics 20, 402-419.
Treitel, 6. (1967).Principles of digital Wiener filtering. Geophys. Pro8pect. 15, 311-333.
Zurflueh, E. G. (1967). Application of two-dimensional linear wavelength atering.
Geophysics 32, 1016-1035.
Distribution Agency, Program Inform. Dept., IBM Corp., 40 Saw Mill Road,
Hawthorne, New York 10532.
Helms, H. D. (1967). Fast Fourier Transform method of computing difference equations
and simulating filters. IEEE Trans. Audio Electroacoustics 15, 86-90.
Singleton, R. C. (1967). A method of computing the Fast Fourier Transform with auxi-
liary memory and limited high-speed storage. IEEE T r a m . Audio Electroacoustics
15,91-98.
Welch, P. D. (1967). The use of the Fast Fourier Transforms for the estimation of power
spectra, a method based on time averaging over short, modified periodograms.
IEEE Trans. Audio Electroacoustics 15, 70-73.
G . Second derivative method
Agarwd, B. N. P., and Lal, T. (1972a). A generalized method of computing second
derivative of gravity field. Cieophya. Prospect. 20, 386-394.
260 FRANS DE MEYER
Agarwal, B. N. P., and Lal, T. (1972b). Calculation of the vertical gravity field using
the Fourier transform. Geophys. Prospect. 20, 44-57.
Danes, 2. F., and Oncley, I. A. (1962). An analysis of some second derivative methods.
Geophysics 27, 611-615.
Elkins, T. A. (1950). The second derivative method of gravity interpretation. Geophysics
16, 29-50.
Henderson, R. G., and Zietz, I. (1949). The computations of second vertical derivatives
of geomagnetia fields. Geophysics 14, 508-616.
Mesk6, C. A. (1966). Two-dimensional filtering and the second derivative method.
Geophysics 31, 606-617.
Rosenbach, 0. (1963). A contribution t o the computation of the second derivative from
gravity data. Geophysics 18, 894-912.
H. Related topics
Agarwal, R. G., and Kanasewich, E. R. (1971). Automatic trend analysis and intepre-
tation of potential field data. Geophysics 36, 339-348.
Agoes, V. B. (1951). Least squares residual anomaly determination. G e ~ p h y ~ i c16,
s . 686-
696.
Al-Chalabi, M. (1971). Some studies relating to nonuniqueness in gravity and magnetic
inverse problems. Geophysics 30, 835-855.
Al-Chalabi, M. (1972). Interpretation of gravity anomalies by non-linear optimisation.
Geophys. Prospect. 20, 1-16.
Botezatu, R., Vimrion, M., Seurtu, F., and Cucu, G. (1971). Approximation of the
gravitational attraction of geological bodies. Geophy8. Pmspect. 19, 218-227.
Bott, M. H. P., and Smith, R. A. (1958). T h e estimation of the limiting depth of gravi-
tating bodies. Geophys. Prospect. 0, 1-10.
Cordell, L., and Henderson, R. G. (1968). Iterative three-dimensional solution of gravity
anomaly data using a digital computer. 33, No. 4, 596-602.
Grant, F. S. (1951e). Three-dimensional interpretation of gravitational anomalies. Part
I. Geophysics 17, 344-364.
Grant, F. S. (1951b). Three-dimensional interpretation of gravitational anomaiies.
Part 11. Geophysics 17, 756-789.
Grant, F. 6. (1953). A theory for the regional correction of potential field data. Geophysics
19, 23-45.
Grant, F. S . (1957). A problem in the analysis of geophysicaldata. Geophysics 22,309-344.
Grant, F. S. (1972). Review of data processing and interpretation methods in gravity
and magnetics, 1964-1971. Geophysics 37, 647-661.
Griffin, W. R. (1948). Residual gravity in theory and practice. Geophysics 14, 39-56.
Henderson, R. G., and Cordell, L. (1971). Reduction of unevenly spaced potential field
data to a horizontal plane by means of finite harmonic series. Geaphysica 36,856866.
Kreisel, 0. (1948). Some remarks on integral equations with kernels, A ( [ , - xl,. ., .
.f,, - xn, a).Proc. Roy.SOC.Ser. A 107, 160-178.
Kunaratnam, K. (1972). An iterative method for the solution of a non-linear inverse
problem in magnetic interpretation. Geophys. Prospect. 20, 439-447.
La Porte, M. (1972). Elaboration rapide des cartes gravimQtriquesdbduites de l’anomalie
de Bouguer B I’aide d’une caloulatrice Qlectronique.Geophys. Proepect. 10,23&257.
Nagy, D. (1966). The gravitational attractiyn of a right rectangular prism. Geophysics 31,
362-371.
Naidu, P. S. (1967). Statistical properties of potential fields over a random medium.
Geophysks 32, 88-98.
FILTER TECHNIQUES IN GRAVITY INTERPRETATION 261
1. INTRODUCTION
When the f%st images o f the earth’s outer appearance were obtained from
orbital altitudes, specialists in various fields of research became aware of a
new, exceptionally effective means of studying the earth’s natural resources
and the processes taking place on its surface. Sciences dealing with the earth
were offered the possibility, on the one hand, to rise to a new level of extensive
generalizations regarding the geological and geographical structure of the
planet and, on the other hand, to obtain regional information enabling more
reliable regional assessments for the rational development and mastering of
natural resources.
The use of information obtained from the orbital altitudes was preceded
by the successful application of other aerial methods. The necessity for
rapidly acquiring data on the natural resources of the enormous territory
of the USSR for their efficient exploration and use required the development
of methods of remote sensing from aircraft, based on the use of the electro-
2. RADARAERIALSURVEY
2.1. Procedures
The advent of side-looking radar systems brought with it a considerable
increase in the resolution of the images obtained, enabling their use for
studying wider areas of the country. This was also stimulated by the
quest of specialists t o use the small-scale images for study of large
territories, an aim which cannot always be attained through aerial photo-
graphy because of meteorological obstacles. I n this case the small-scale images
served as a kind of bridge in passing from the materials of traditional aerial
photography to extra small-scale images obtained from space altitudes.
I n the USSR the side-looking radar system TOROS was developed for
the purpose of ice exploration, which in a very short time has found wide
application for both the evaluation and the prognosis of ice conditions. This
266 B. V. SRILJX AND V. B. ROMAROV
FIG.I.(a) Aerial radar image of ice cover. (b)Aerial photograph of the same part of
ice cover
AERIAL GEOLOGICAL-GEOGRAPHICAL EXPLORATIONS 269
route for a ship convoy. Figure 2 gives a radar image fixing the route of a
ship convoy through gray ice to open water.
The interpretation of radar images permits compilation of operational ice
charts along the whole route of a ship convoy. They are much more detailed
and accurate than those compiled from visual observations.
The extensive application of radar images in geological exploration was
prompted by the ‘‘ all-weather ” availability of the method and the possibility
FIa. 2. Aerial radar image of gray ice floe. White line-route of the caravan; white
bright points on open water and near the outlet from the ice-separate ships of the
caravan (V.S. Loshtshilov’s material).
270 B. V. SHILIN AND V. B. KOMAROV
of quickly obtaining small-scale images for vast meas (up to ten thousands
of square kilometers), as well as adequate representation of the main
indicators of geological structure-relief, hydrographic pattern, surface
texture, humidity, vegetation, and top soil-as used in usual aerial photo-
graphic interpretation.
In some instances the radar survey has an advantage over the photo-
graphic survey as a result of a peculiar " sculpturedness') defining various
elements of relief (the main indicator of geological structure) and the-gener-
alization of small immaterial details of landscape on radar images, which
are often a hindrance in studying the aerial photograph (Fig. 3).
The morphological features of each type of relief are determined by the
material composition of the rocks, their stability against weathering, the
AERIAL GEOLOGICAL-GEOGRAPHIC& EXPLORATIONS 27 1
FIQ.3. Aerial photograph (a) and aerial radar image (b) of a district of the Kam-
chatka Eastern volcanic belt. Due to lower resolution on radar image small landscape
details are smooth, particularly the small structure of lava flows and covers. Accordingly,
the regional break marked by the chain of small volcanic cones is shown somewhat more
distinctly. I n a number of cases the contrasts of some objects (e.g. bright bare sections
on the aerial photograph) are changed.
character of clefts, and the amplitude of the most recent tectonic movements
which are especially sharply defined on radar images.
Besides the morphological types of relief, its individual forms, such as
ridges, mounds, washout cones, beds of waterways, terraces, as well as
the elements of its forms (shelves, slopes, edges), are well shown on the radar
272 B. V. SHILIN AND V. B. KOMAROV
FIG.4. Aerial radar image of Middle Asia mountain region (a) and scheme of its
geological interpretation results (b) (composed by V. A. Starostin). 1-limestone, 2-
marl, 3---clay marl, 4--conglomerate, 5-sandstono, 6-aleurolite, 7-clay, 8-loam,
9-sandy 1 am, 10-faults, 11-boundaries of lithologo-stratigraphicdivisions.
being equal. I n some cases a sharp difference is observed in the tone range of
the objects on the aerial photographs and radar aerial images (Fig. 3).
Occasionally, when rocks lie horizontally and irregularities of their texture
are less than one-half wavelength, there will be a nearly specular reflection
of the latter and the rocks will be of dark tone in the image.
I n this way, with due consideration of the character of the surface texture,
the relief features (slope angles), cleft characteristics, the character of the
erosion pattern, the degree of humidity, and the development of vegetation,
it is possible t o distinguish between rocks of different composition. Clearly
defined border lines between the lithologic-stratigraphic subdivisions em-
phasized by the above-mentioned features enable one to determine the
geological structure of the region.
An example of interpreting a sedimentary series of rocks is presented in
Fig. 4. On the radar image one can easily identify the carbonate and terrigene
274 B. V. SHILW AND V. B. KOMAROV
Fra. 5b. Various geological formations in the region of Karymski volcano (composed
by N. A. Gussev). 1-volcanic foundation, plateau composed of pyroclastic and lava
products of different thickness; 2-recent alluvial and lake deposits filling the most
depressed parts of relief; 3-tuff deposits of the southern complex bearing no relation
to the structure of Karymski volcano; 4-young lava and agglomerate flows of the
recent Karymski volcano; 5-Volcanic deposits of other eruption centers: a-mainly
lava, b-mainly pyroclastic; "recent ash-lava deposits of Karymski volcano; 7-
geological border lines: a-interpreted with assurance, be-interpreted with incertitude;
8-border of ancient Karymski volcano and Dvor volcano; 9 4 a l d e r a scarp of the main
structure and active volcano; 10-Lakes.
276 B. V. SHILIN AND V. B. KOMAROV
rocks of chalk, paleogene, and neogen, while the border lines of individual
formations are traced more distinctly as compared to aerial photographs.
Friable Quarternary deposits, especially the takyr regions, and shores with
different degrees of salinity, moisture, and surface texture are well dis-
tinguished as regards their material composition.
The volcanogenic and intrusive rocks, especially dikes and dike belts,
stand out by the morphology of relief, the character of clefts, and other
features. It should be noted that the image contrast of the dikes and other
linear geological objects, including faults, depends upon their position
relative to the scanning beam. The dikes are especially well displayed when in
a perpendicular position relative to the direction of radiation and much
worse when oriented in parallel.
The interpretation of volcanic formations is exemplified by Fig. 5 , which
presents the varying composition of eruptive products for the active volcano
Karymski on Kamchatka [Fig. 5(b)]. Aerial radar surveys permit adequate
interpretation of the lava streams of the volcano’s main cone and their
relationships, and the flat surfaces characteristic of the areas of young lake
and river sediment deposits.
fractured zones, differing in age and significance, which might serve for ore
discovery. On the basis of the geological analysis of aerial radar images
schemes of tectonic fractures were plotted for these regions.
Comparison of the interpretation results for aerial radar images and
geophysical explorations revealed good agreement. This suggests the possi-
bility of using the aerial radar images for mapping the fractures which are not
sufficiently visible on the surface and which are inadequately h e d by the
usual geological methods, but a t the same time are noted during geophysical
observations.
A distinct interpretation of tectonic fractures on radar images suggests
their use for the study of block tectonic structure (Fig. 6). An example of
FIG.6. Aerial radar image of block st,ructure region of upper Paleozoic effusives in
Kazakh fold country (a) and fractures limiting the rocky blocks (b). Fractures are inter-
preted with certainty according to the orientation of the erosional pattern large elements,
zones of increased humidity, and zones of vegetation cover development.
(b)
FIG.7. Aerial radar image of the region of submountain proluvial plane (a) end
its structural-tectonic structure (b) (composed by V. A. Starostin). Designations:
1-fractures, 2-structural lines.
As stated above, these indicators are easily identified on the radar aerial
images and, using them, it is possible to interpret the hidden structures. I n
the regions of recent sinking and rising of foundation the tone differencesare
very important. In addition, the orientation of the relief and hydropattern
forms, in particular the sharp changes in direction of elements of the erosion
patterns, are also of vital importance.
The closed tectonic fractures along which the tectonic movements took
place are interpreted on the radar aerial images by the oriented contours of
the humidification zones, “ straightened ” portions of erosional pattern,
contacts of the contour configuration and structure differing in tone, and
pattern of the image.
AERIAL GEOLOGICAL4:EOGRAPHICAL EXPLORATIONS 281
m1
pJz
FIG.8. Aerial radar imago of agricultural region (a) and the results of its interprctation
(composed by N. N. Semyonova). Drsig~iations:1-fallow fields, 2--unsuitahle, erodcd,
old arable lands. The numerals on the scheme indicate: 1-wheat, 2-millct, 3-barlc.y,
4-maize.
282 B. V. SHILIN AND V. B. KOMAROV
Thus, science and research have gained a new highly efficient means for the
investigation of the earth’s surface which, together with other available means
for obtaining information (aerial photography, aerogeophysics, etc.), will
promote the extension of our knowledge of the natural resources.
3. INFRARED
AERIAL SURVEY
3.1. General
The development of this method for compiling thermal charts of the earth’s
surface is associated with the great success of infrared techniques in recent
years. The usefulness and extension of this application in studying natural
resources are predicated on the fact that many natural and artificial objects
and phenomena are accompanied by temperature contrasts. The landscape
elements with abnormally high temperatures are most readily studied by
infrared aerial surveys. Consequently, at the present time infrared aerial
survey has found a fairly wide and efficient application in the study of regions
of recent volcanism (Gussev et al., 1972; Shilin et al., 1969, 1971) and for
fighting forest fires.
Some results for the first of the above-mentioned applications are given
below. The specifics of using the infrared aerial surveys in this case require a
separate consideration of their use for studying the active volcanoes and the
associated regions of strong geothermal activity.
The infrared aerial survey was carried out from the aircraft Li-2 with the
aid of an infrared scanner, whose detailed description has been given by
Shilin et al. (1971).
maximum in 1971. Fresh lava streams descended the slopes of the volcano.
The period of gas-ash outbursts was reduced to a few minutes. I n 1971 the
activity decreased; during the surveys in October 1972, the outbursts
occurred every few hours, The crater configuration changed, compared to
1967: it had the shape of a slightly extended oval, but the direction of the
long axis changed from NW to SW. The results of the survey in 1967 are
given by Shilin et aZ. (1969).
I n 1972 the infrared aerial survey was carried out from two altitudes (400
and 800 m) and a t different levels of signal discrimination (Fig. 9), which
allowed the obtaining of extensive information on the crater structure. The
infrared image 9(b) was obtained in the spectral interval with a minimum
width of 4.65.3 p (enabling the complete elimination of the influence of the
sun) and with a small level of signal discrimination. As a result, the general
scheme of crater thermal fields and adjacent regions was revealed [Fig. 9(c)].
A similar, but slightly more detailed, scheme is provided by the interpretation
of the infrared image 9(d) obtained a t a somewhat higher level of discrimina-
tion. On that image the weakly heated peripheral areas of the anomalies have
disappeared and the infrared image 9(d) acquired a somewhat greater
distinctness as compared to the preceding one. The analysis of infrared
images demonstrates that the thermal fields of the crater (slightly nonuni-
form in their structure) have the shape of a figure eight extended in the
direction of the crater oval. Intense anomalies of arch-like form are observed
on the NW rim of the crater. A large but somewhat weaker anomaly is
noted on the southern slope, about 80-100 m below its edge. The visual
observations and analysis of the aerial photograph indicate that all these
anomalies are connected with exceptionally active fumarole fields and large
ascent channels over which an intensive gas emission is observed. The
chains of anomalies on the N W slope are due to the anomalous heating of a
young lava stream.
The thermal structure of the crater shown in Fig. 9(c) is confirmed and
shown with improved accuracy by the infrared images 9(e) and (f) obtained
from a lower altitude under close measuring conditions-an average level of
discrimination and narrow spectral limitations of 4.6-5.3 p in (e) and 4.2-
5.3 p in (f). I n accordance with the wider interval in the last case, the portions
which are accentuated on the infrared image have a slightly greater area than
the images of 9(e) due to the passing of the signal from the less heated parts
of the crater. The analysis of these infrared images demonstrates that in the
crater part of the volcano the most active and most heated is its SW area,
whose thermal structure has almost not changed as compared to that shown
in Figs. 9(b) and (d). The intensity of the anomaly is considerably reduced
in the NE area, where some local parts are accentuated. The anomaly chain
of arch-like shape is distinctly observed on the NW rim of the crater. The
FIG.9.(a) Plan of aerial photograph of the Karymski volcano crater. Scale 1: 5,000.
(b) Infrared image of the Karymski volcano crater. Scale 1: 20,000. Spectral interval
4.6-5.3 p. Flight altitude 800 m. Time 11: 10 a.m. Low level of signal discrimination. (c)
General scheme of the volcano crater and its environment’s geothermal fields. Scale
1: 20,000. (d) Infrared image. Scale 1: 20,000. Spectral interval 4.6-5.3 p. Flight altitude
800 m. Time 11: 12 a.m. Low level of signal discrimination. (e),(f) Infrared images.
Scale 1: 10,000. Spectral interval 4.6-5.3 p . Flight altitude 400 m. Time 11: 18 a.m.,
11: 22 a.m. and 11: 28 a.m. Medium level of signal discrimination. (g) Geothermal fields
of volcano crater from data of infrared images 9(e)and (f) interpretation. Scale 1: 10,000.
Medium level of signal discrimination allows the revelation of the geothermal fields of
high intensity. (h),(i) Infrared images. Scale 1: 10,000. Spectral interval $65.3 p.
Flight altitude 400 m. Time 11: 32 a.m. and 11: 38 a.m. High level of signal discrimination.
( j ) Volcanic crater ascent channels scale from data of infrared images 9(h) and (i) inter-
pretation. Scale 1: 10,000. High level of signal discrimination allows the revelation of the
crater ascent channels-the objects of the highest temperature and intensity of radiation.
284
285
286 B. V. SHILL" AND V. B. KOMAROV
FIG. 11. Mosaic of infrared images of the central part of caldera Uson. Spectral
interval 3.2-5.3 p. Flight altitude 800 m. Daytime, clear weather, separate clouds
Survey of 1967.
290 B. V. SHILIN AND V. B. KOMAROV
and well heated elements of relief. It has been established that in September
the contrast between shaded and sunlit slopes in this region may reach
15-18°C. However, the intensity of the apparent anomalies on the infrared
images makes it possible to overlook the anomalies caused by geothermal
phenomena, as further study has proved.
The first group of anomalies is interpreted more simply, as under the con-
ditions of a practically 0at relief the presence of apparent anomalies has been
reduced to a minimum. An important role is played by the shape and location
of these anomalies, their direct connection to the areas of bright (hydro-
thermally changed) rocks on the aerial photograph and-especially significant
-with the water surfaces of lakes, rivers, and streams. The combined inter-
pretation of large-scale aerial photographs (1: 5,000 1 : 8,000) with infrared
images allows the determination of some types of thermal phenomena
according to their specific indications (Gussev et al., 1972). Many of the
open thermal phenomena of the caldera (Fig. 14) may be determined by
means of indirect interpretation, after performing some field work a t the
test sites.
However, in the initial stage of analyzing the data obtained by aeromethods
in 1967, a scheme of thermal activities (Fig. 12) was compiled, and the
anomalies were divided into two groups: the white color designated the
anomalies which, with a great degree of certainty, may be connected with
geothermal objects; the spotted part indicated the anomalies requiring
ground exploration to determine their nature. The latter particularly concern
the areas of weak heating of landscape elements near intensive thermal
phenomena observed on infrared images.
Based on the results of 1967 and subsequent local checks, in 1972 the
infrared aerial survey of the central part of caldera Uson was carried out from
a lower altitude (600 m) and in the spectral interval of 4.2-5.3 p, which
allowed the infrared image of thermal phenomena to be obtained on a larger
scale and almost without the interference of insolation (Fig. 13). This, in
turn, allowed a scheme of caldera thermal phenomena (Fig. 14) to be plotted,
differing in detail and reliability from the data of 1967. It suffices t o say that
in the survey of 1972 only two thernial areas in the lower part are doubtful
(4 in Fig. 14).
I n Fig. 13 the structure of lakes and thermal fields is interpreted in more
detail; even small thermal objects, such as small single springs, baths, and
Vud pots are determined with assurance. Measurements of temperatures on
the terrain a t the moment of aerial survey provided the following results; a
hot lake (1 on Fig. 13) +38"C, a cold stream (2) +6"C, a mud bath (3) +52"C,
the lake Vosmyorka (4) +lS"C, the spring near the lake shore on the central
fumarole field (5) 45"C, soil in the inactive area (6) f12"C.
For a detailed test of the representativeness of the infrared aerial survey
AERIAL GEOLOGICAL-GEOGRAPHICAL EXPLORATIONS 291
Fro. 13. Mosaic of infrared images of the caldera Uson central part. Scale 1: 12,000.
Spectral interval 4.2-5.3 p. Flight altitude 600 m. Daytime, clear weather, separate
clouds. Survey of 1972. Numerals and arrows indicate the sites of land temperature
measurements during the aerial survey.
AERIAL GEOLOGICAL-GEOGRAPHICAL EXPLORATIONS 293
.
\
4.
v
FIG.14. Geothermal activities in the central part of caldera Uson from data of infra-
red aerial survey of 1972. Designations: 1-geothermal objects, warm rivers and the most
heated parhs of the lakes; 2-parts of lakes with medium geothermal heating; 3-parts
of lakes with weak geothermal heating; 4-supposed anomalous regions requiring
additional field checkup; I I a and IIb-two actlve parts of central fumarole field. -
294 B. V. SHILIN AND V. B. KOMBROV
data while mapping the thermal activity of the area of anomalies revealed,
surface thermometrical measurements with a grid of 50 x 50 m, as well as
soil and geological observations, were conducted in 1968. The grid was
transferred to a more accurate photomosaic with a scale of about 1 : 5,000.
In the most interesting anomaly areas the grid was narrowed to 25 x 10 m.
All the open thermal activities (springs, gas-steam jets, mud pots, etc.)
were measured by contact mercury thermometers with a range of 0°C to
50°C subdivided into 0.5"C. For the open thermal activities maximum
thermometers were also used. The observation point temperatures were
determined, both on the surface and to depths of 20 and 50 cm.
The data a t the 50 cm depths were used since the influence there of daily
temperature fluctuations could be neglected, and they were therefore best
for comparison with the infrared aerial survey data. The values of the
measured temperatures were plotted on a photomosaic (scale 1 :5,000) with
the identification of the observation point on the aerial photograph. Iso-
therms were plotted separately for the ground and reservoirs in order t o
obtain a better description (Fig. 15).
Using the results of soil-geological observations a t the points where
temperature was measured, a map of open thermal activities was obtained
(Fig. 16), where the areas of strongest geothermal activity are accentuated,
namely the areas of the Eastern (Fig. 16, I ) and Central (Fig. 16,II)fumarole
fields as well as the area of Fumarole Lake-Central Lake.
A comparison of Figs. 12, 15, and 16 shows that all the anomalies revealed
by the infrared aerial survey coincide with the areas of strong geothermal
activity. As a rule, the anomalies of the first type (Fig. 12, white tone, and
Figs. 11, 13) correspond t o the open thermal activities or separate objects
(Fig. 16)-gas steam jets, hot water and mud pots, thermal springs, etc.,
i.e. areas with the highest temperature (Fig. 15), whereas anomalies of the
second type (Fig. 12, spotted part) correspond to the areas with lower
anomalous temperature (20-25°C) that border the open thermal activities.
The comparative analysis of infrared images, photo interpretation data,
thermometrical surveys, and the distribution of geothermal activities enables
one to draw the following conclusions. All data of the infrared surveys are
fully confimed by the results of field observations, the zones of anomalies
coinciding with the areas of strongest thermal activity (Fig. 16) and highest
temperature (Fig. 15), i.e. areas with the convective type of anomalous heat
flow (Shilin et al., 1969). The scheme of thermal activities in 1972 is much
more detailed than the corresponding data for 1967. I n this scheme it is
possible to divide the anomalies of the Central fumarole field into two active
areas (IIa and IIb, Fig. 14)and to note a whole series of thermal objects which
have not been determined by the infrared survey of 1967.
On the thermometrical representation, the isolines of which result from
AERIAL GEOLOGICAL-GEOGRAPHICAL EXPLORATIONS 295
considerable averaging of the true picture of the thermal field with respect
to space and time (the measurements were conducted during two months),
it is possible to identify only the general contours of the areas with a strong
geothermal activity without revealing the specific objects, their shape or
size. This information, which is of paramount importance for the further
geological exploration, may be obtained in considerable detail only by means
of infrared aerial surveys. As demonstrated in Shilin et al. (1969), the
numerous surveys a t different levels of registered signal discrimination in the
receptor channel of the equipment enable one t o reveal zones with various
anomalous heating (as was done for the Karymski volcano and for hot
streams on the slope of Kihpinych volcano), which greatly increases the scope
of geological information.
The results of laboratory and field interpretation of the aerial photo-
graphic surveys and infrared aerial surveys allow one to discern the presence
of two systems of breaks, in northwestern (principal) and northeastern
directions, that cut the central part of the caldera, but these are characteristic
for the whole caldera and the surrounding region as shown by the available
geological data. These breaks in both directions and especially the weakened
areas of their intersections are practically all associated with known geo-
thermal activities.
On the extension of the main zone of the N W strike (Fig. la), passing
through the Eastern and Central fumarole fields and Lake Fumarole an
exceptionally active Western fumarole field (studied by means of infrared
aerial survey in 1972) is also known to exist.
Another example of mapping an area with various great thermal activities
by means of aerial methods is presented in the results obtained for the well-
known Geyser Valley (Ustinova, 1955; Vinogradov, 1964) located a t the foot
of the volcano Kihpinych. The Geyser River flowing from the volcano cuts
into a powerful complex of volcanic rocks represented by lavas and tuffs of
andesite and dacitic composition. In the area of the main thermal activities
the river forms a narrow canyon cut t o a depth of more than 300 m a t the
absolute depth of its surrounding plateau of about 800-1000 m. Because of the
presence of the volcano in the vicinity of a high massif, the character of the
relief seems to be very unfavorable for getting the data from the large-scale
aerial surveys. However, in 1967 and in 1972 we succeeded in obtaining data
enabling us to plot sufficiently detailed schemes of thermal activities.
The thermal activities in the form of hot springs with various discharges,
steam jets, mud pots and small lakes, geysers, thermal platforms, etc. are
known over the whole length of the Geyser River valley, with the following
regularity being observed in their arrangement (Ustinova, 1955). Close to the
river the massive-yield hot springs are situated, a little higher-the geysers
and hot springs with small and varying discharge. In the upper part of the
296 B. V. SHILIN AND V. B. KOMAROV
FIG.18. Thermometric scheme of the central part of caldera Uson from data of
field temperature measurements (in "C).Scale 1 : 12000. (Composedby E. I. Vavilov and
B. V. Shilin.)
AERIAL GEOLOGICAGGEOCRAPHICAL EXPLORATIONS 297
!
I Gas-vapor jets
2 Hot water pots
3 Mud p o t s
4 S m a l l mud volcanoes
5 Hot a n d worm springs
6 A r e a o f strongest
termal activity
FIG. 16. Scheme of geothermal activities in the central part of caldera Uson
(I-activities in the Eastern fumarole field, 11-activities in the Central fumarole
field). (Composed by E. I. Vavilov.)
298 B. V. SRILIN AND V. B. KOWOV
slopes the steam wells, mud pots, and small lakes are to be noted, mainly on
the terrace in the middle part of the slope.
The aerial survey was carried out over the middle (and thermally most
active) part of the Geyser River. The results are shown in Figs. 17-20.
FIQ.17. Plan of aerial photograph of the most geothermally active part of Geyser
Valley. Soale 1 : 10,000,
Fro. 18. Mosaic of infrared images of the mme part of the valley. Scale 1: 16,000.
Spectral interval 4.2-6.3 p Flight altitude 600 m. Daytime, clear weather, separate
clouds. Survey of 1972.
300 B. V. SHILIN AND V. B. KOMAROV
FIQ.19. Thermal activities of Geyser Valley from data of infrared aerial survey, 1972.
The numerals show geothermal regions. The thermal field VIII is shown shaded due to
the impossibility of detailed distinction between separate objects.
shaded areas, as well as heavy cloudiness during the flight of 1967, enabled
us to distinguish easily on the infrared images between the bright local
anomalies of thermal activities with sharp contours and pale broad anomalies
connected with solar heating.
Figure 21 shows the arrangement of thermal activities compiled by
former investigators according to field observations (Vinogradov, 1964). The
pattern includes the geysers (l),the main pulsing sources (2),and the so-called
thermal areas (3) which imply the accumulation of active areas of various
thermal activities and whose determination is very conventional.
FIG.21. Scheme of geothermal objects in Geyser Valley from the data of field observ-
ations of the Institute for Volcanology. Designations: 1-geysers (1-Rozovi Konus, 2-
Horizontal, 3--Zhemchushni, PVelkian, 5-Nepostoyanni, 6-Dvoynoy, 7-Fontan,
8-Novi Fontan, g-shchel’, 10-Bolshoy, 1 I-Malyi, 12-Konus, 13-Bolshaya
Pechka) ; 2-main pulsating springs ( 1-Paryashchi, 2-Plachushchi, a-Nepreryvni,
4-Grot, 5-Malahitovyi grot, 6-Malaya Pechka, 7--Kamenka, 8-Skalisti, 9-Vorota
v Geyzernuju); 3-the most active geothermal regions.
springs situated in the vicinity discharge into the river. The latter are
interpreted on the infrared image as slightly stretched anomalies suggesting
" commas " by their shape. The heating of these objects essentially exceeds
the heating of the river, which enables one to identify them as independent
thermal activities. However, their direct connection with the river demon-
strates that they are warm springs, whose discharge is not great and does not
cause an appreciable increase in the temperature of the river water. Here
again, near the river, a little higher along its left bank, a few small point-like
thermal activities, apparently gas-steam jets, are revealed.
Further west occur anomalies of complex thermal structure (11), with the
southwestern part undoubtedly due to the intensive heat of the geysers
Velikan, Zhemchuzhni, Horizontalni, Rozovi Konus, the pulsating spring
Paryashtshi of small geysers, and hot water and steam discharges connected
with them. However, a considerable part of the thermal field of this district
is connected with the slope of the right bank of Geyser River.
An intensive group of anomalies stretched along the following rectilinear
river district (111)is connected with the geysers Dvoynoi, Nepostoyanni,
Fontan, Novi Fontan, the high-discharge pulsating springs Grot, Malahitovi
Grot, and others. A high, and comparatively constant, discharge of these
thermal objects resulted in a high intensity of infrared radiation of this group
of anomalies.
The ring of local anomalies (IV) is connected with the thermal activities
of the terrace on the left bank of the Geyser River and the valley of its small
warm effluent. The thermal activities are represented by numerous small warm
lakes, mud pots, gas steam jets, heated platforms, and in the effluent valley
also by hot springs and small geysers (Ustinova, 1955; Vinogradov, 1964).
The temperature of the objects varies from a few tens of degrees in small warm
lakes up to the boiling point in geysers and springs. The terrace consists
almost completely of hydrothermally changed warm, claylike, opalized
rocks covered with thick high grass and shrubbery. Only the areas of thermal
activity are free from vegetation. The data of the infrared aerial survey and
aerial photographic survey demonstrate that the western, more elevated
part of the terrace has no active areas, whereas a ring structure (of great
interest for further geological work) occupies its middle and eastern parts.
I n a similar region of Iceland this kind of structure, though much greater in
scale, has been identified through infrared surveys.
About 150-200 m to the west of the ring structure, the infrared aerial
survey reveals a group of three anomalies (V) connected with the hydro-
thermally changed and heated rocks in the upper part of the southern slope
of the Geyser River valley. There, although only small discharges of steam
jets are observed, the intensity of the anomaly indicates high intensity heat
flow, which had not been noted in prior investigations.
AERIAL GEOLOGICAGQEOGRAPHICAL EXPLORATIONS 303
The anomalous zone VI, which for some reason or other has not been
mentioned before (Ustinova, 1955; Vinogradov, 1964), should be particularly
identified, as the character of the heat anomalies proves that they are caused
not only by the warm water of the Geyser River, but also by thermal objects
located on the right bank. These, in all probability, are small springs; on the
infrared image they are connected with the river.
Downstream of the Geyser River, where the valley is a narrow canyon
with steep, up to 70°, slopes (Vinogradov, 1964), two thermal anomalies
had been previously identified (Fig. 21): the region of geysers Bolshoi and
Malyi a t the beginning of the canyon and the region of the geysers Konus
and Bolshaya Petchka. The analysis of the aerial photograph and the
infrared images gives an essentially new picture of the thermal structure of
this zone (VII): from the region of geysers Bolshoi and Malyi the zone is
divided into two parallel subzones. The northern subzone is connected with the
anomaly from the warm waters of the Geyser River flowing into it from the
adjacent small springs, from geysers Konus and Bolshaya Petchka, and the
pulsating springs Skalistyi and Kamenka. The southern subzone is con-
nected with the thermal discharges of the right slope in the upper part of the
river. Apparently, these discharges are not accompanied by outflow of warm
water, as on the infrared image no connection with the river is observed.
The eighth anomalous group (VIII) coincides with the region of thermal
activity located 500 m higher than the mouth of the stream flowing into the
Geyser River on its right bank, where the active region rises up to a height
of 50 m. Here many mud pots, gas steam jets, springs, etc. are situated,
whose water appreciably increases the temperature of the stream, a fact well
discernible on the infrared image.
I n summary, the infrared aerial survey distinctly reveals all the anomalous
zones of the main thermal region of the Geyser Valley and its inner structure,
and the mass of information largely exceeds the data of many years of field
observations. The data of infrared aerial surveys may serve as a basis for
subsequent detailed geological field investigations of the structure and
origin of thermal zones.
The comparison of the infrared aerial surveys of 1967 and 1972 proves that,
when the flight altitude is reduced, the detail of geothermal objects is some-
what increased, and the reduction of the spectral interval width (from 3.2 p
to 4.2 p ) practically eliminates the losses resulting from solar heating and
from reflected solar radiation. It should also be noted that no appreciable
changes took place in the structure of the geothermal activities of the
Geyser Valley during the last five years.
I n conclusion, i t may be said that the large-scale infrared aerial survey
permitted the study with sufficient detail of the geothermal fields and the
active volcanoes of the Eastern volcanic belt from the volcano Karymski in
304 B. V. SHILIN AND V. B. KOMAROV
the south up to Lake Kronotski in the north. The study of the regional
geological structure of this region undoubtedly indicates the presence of an
interconnection between these objects. However, this important inter-
connection is revealed only on the infrared aerial surveys of sufficiently
small scale (less than 1 : 100000) which were carried out many times under
favorable conditions at night different levels of signal discrimination.
4.1. Method
The method to be considered now is based upon recording from aircraft
the volatile elements and compounds evaporated by surface objects into the
atmosphere. By analogy with the widely used geochemical surveys studying
the haloes of dispersion of chemical elements and compounds in soils and
rocks (Ginzburg, 1957), one may label these “gas haloes” or “evaporation
haloes” in the near-surface layer of the atmosphere and call such studies
aerogeochemical surveys.
To the volatile elements and compounds, which are of interest from the
geological-geochemicalpoint of view, belong in the first place the halogens,
sulfurous gas, hydrogen sulfide, a number of hydrocarbons, mercury (to a
certain extent), etc. The work of Berringer discusses the great potential
of using aerogeochemicalsurveys in geology for seeking sulfur-sulfide deposits
by SO, haloes, oil deposits by SO, and iodine haloes, and polymetallic
deposits by mercury haloes (Barringer, 1964; Barringer and Schork, 1966;
Barringer et al., 1968).
Among recent work, the report (Rouse and Stevens, 1970) on the study of
SO, haloes over the sulfide deposits merits consideration. According to the
geological conditions (mainly the thickness of overlying sediments, the
presence of faults, and weather factors), the SO, concentration varies from
0.03 to 1.0 mg/m3, when the measurements are taken from an automobile
and from a helicopter with flight speed up to 40 miles/hr.
The available general geological and geochemical research suggests a
potential use for aerogeochemical survey. However, the actual data are
evidently inadequate for organizing operations in the search for minerals. In
particular, there are practically no data on field measurements of gas con-
centration in the air over mining fields and over oil fields. Accordingly, it
seems more appropriate to conduct the experimental flights on objects with
exceptionally pronounced haloes of evaporation, namely the active vol-
canoes and regions of strong geothermal activity.
AERIAL GEOLOGICAL-CEOGRAPIIICAL EXPLORATIONS 305
part of the plume and the flight proceeded normal to the plume, usually a t a
speed of 100 km/hr or less. On the signal of the navigator a recorder was
switched on and the polyethylene sacks were filled. Usually the flight time
through the plume lasted tens of seconds. During the turn of the helicopter
preceding the next approach to the plume, the gas concentrations in the sacks
were measured. I n the plume of an explosion only one or two passes were
made because the plume dispersed rapidly. Sometimes the sequence of
volcanic explosions was so rapid that the helicopter did not land in between.
AERIAL GEOLOGICAL-GEOGRAPHICAL EXPLORATIONS 307
I n only two years more than seventy measurements were made over the
voIcano Karymski. An example of the recording of the anomalous concen-
tration of gas in the plume is shown in Fig. 23.
I n flights over the thermal activities of the caldera Uson, the concentra-
tion of gases was measured under different flight regimes (altitude, speed) in
various meteorological conditions. The altitude varied between 5 and 40 m,
while the method of specimen sampling was nearly the same as that used
over the volcano, although the navigator had to be very careful while giving
the signals for sampling because of the extremely small size of the objects in
this case. Measurements made directly by the apparatus were done only
while hovering. Besides, all measurements, about 60 of them, were made only
in flights against the wind.
Fro. 23. Example of recording the anomalous concentration in the train of outbursts
of volcano Karymski.
Over the fumarole fields of the caldera Uson some measurements were
made in the regions of the most active exhalations of the Central and Eastern
fumarole fields, represented by sectors that are very close to thermal springs,
boiling baths, and gas-steam jets (Fig. 24) which noisily emit great quantities
of gas and steam. The smell of hydrogen sulfide in calm weather is noted a t a
distance of many meters. During field measurements over these objects, the
+
values of the total concentration of SO, H,S varied from 1.5 mg/m3 (with
the apparatus installed a t a height of 3.5 m) up to 4.5mg/m3 (for its position
near the edge of the boiling baths). The maximum concentration (of more
than 20 mg/m3) has been noticed when the intake tube was introduced
directly into the mouth of the gas discharge channels.
Thus a few field measurements have shown a very rapid decrease of gas
308 B. V. SHlLIN AND V. B. KOMAROV
concentration on moving aside and upstream of the spring. These data are in
good agreement with the results of the measurements in air, discussed below,
which indicate that the gas content very quickly decreases with the altitude
due to its dispersion in the air.
continued
TABLEI-Continued
a Key t o abbreviations: CFF central fumarole field; EFF, eastern fumerole field, EFF, C eastern fumarole field, central part; EFF, W
eastern fumarole field, western part.
312 B. V. SHILJN AND V. B. KOMlLROV
The recorded value of the concentration decreases sharply when the speed
of the flight is increased. This becomes evident when comparing, e.g., the
values of Nos. 15, 16 and 19, 20, 9 and 10, 11, etc. In the last case, the in-
0uence of a small increase in speed is even more appreciable than the rise of
the flight altitude which is probably explained by the inertia of the gas
analyzer. This is confirmed by a good coincidence of the data obtained in
measurements from the hovering helicopter (Nos. 10, 11) with the use of the
sampler made of ampoules (Nos. 22, 23), where the intake of the gas for the
subsequent analysis is nearly instantaneous, and excludes the influence of
instrument lag. The disparity of the reading No. 21 (0.04 mg/m3)results from
the incorrect switching on of the sampler at the moment when the helicopter
has nearly ‘(slipped” over the gas halo. This was also the case when the
sample was taken into a polyethylene sack (with No. 24). Here only some
disparities of the values are noted in unsuccessful attempts to sample gas at
the edges of the halo (Nos. 26, 27, 60).
The low value of the concentration when the helicopter was hovering at a
low altitude (No. 35), was due to the unfavorable conditions of intake flow
caused by the helicopter rotor. However, when the helicopter is hovering
with a gas pickup through the intake tubes to the apparatus, high values are
observed which decrease somewhat according to the altitude (Nos. 10, 11).
At a low altitude (6 m) the helicopter practically hovers in the center of the
halo mixing the gas with its rotor and causing an (‘averaging ” of concen-
trations.
Various changes of the wind exert a great influence on the results of
aerial gas surveys. When the wind is strong and gusty, the gas halo “ creeps ”
along the earth, its upper edge drops, and measurements are hampered.
Thus, for example, at a constant altitude and speed of flight (Nos. 12, 13, 1,
and 2)) but with sharp gusty wind, the gas concentration is reduced by one
half as compared with calmer conditions. Evidently, this is also the reason
for the general drop of gas concentration over the Eastern fumarole field on
October 26, 1971 (Nos. 40-50)) as compared to the data obtained ten days
earlier (Nos. 24-33).
These conclusions indicate the changeability, of the gas halo and the
variability of the measured values due to the numerous conditions for
dispersal. This results in great difficulties for the development of such
surveying methods and makes only very generalized rules in the search for
objects of small dimensions possible:
1. The aerogeochemical survey should be carried out from a helicopter at
minimum possible altitudes and optimal speeds.
2. The aerogeochemical survey should be performed under conditions of
calm or steady wind with a speed of not over 10 km/hr. The direction of the
flight should only be upwind, when the conditions for sampling are most
favorable.
AERIAL GEOLOGICAIrGEOCRAPHICAL EXPLORATIONS 313
The most interesting results were obtained over the volcano Karymski.
During October, 1970, the volcano was active, with a period of gas-ash
explosions of 1-2 hr. The duration of an explosion usually did not exceed
1-2 min, the main outburst of ash and gas occurring in the first 5-10 sec.
After the cloud broke away from the crater, only a weak gas escape was
observed from the crater fumaroles. It was easy to notice visually the
changing of color in the outbursts connected with the change of their com-
position and ash content. After the outburst the propagation of the gas cloud
depended on the wind speed and direction, dispersing at a distance of 8-10
km from the volcano. During October 1971 the volcanic activity increased
sharply, the interval between explosions was reduced to a few minutes,
although the visual intensity of the strongest outbursts in our opinion hardly
exceeded the intensity of the similar explosions in 1970. The stable gas plume
extended from the volcano up to the Pacific Ocean coast, where near the
shoreananomalous concentration of SO,, 0.04 mg/m3 (No. 26), was observed.
I n October 1972, a considerable decrease of the volcanic activity was ob-
served; the interval between outbursts increased up to 4-6 hr. I n total,
during four working days of 1970, eight outbursts were investigated, in
1971-twenty nine, in 1 9 7 2 - 4 ~ 0The
. results of the measurements are given
in Table 11.
314 B . V. SHILIN AND V. B. KOMAROV
Distance
to volcano
Heli- Content
Date and Time of Flight from Wind
copter of
Remarks
Serial
No.
time of
explosions
measure-
ment
altitude measure-
ment
speed
speed
Course
so2 + H2S
point
(4 (W (WW (WW (mg/m3)
1971
Volcano Karmski
1 10.16.1970 11:09 a.m. 1800 4.0 30 100 310 1.8 Clear weather, separate clouds
11: 00 a.m.
Volcano Malyi Semlyachek, crater lake
2 10.16.1970 11: 18 a.m. 0 0.5-0.7 20 100 100 0.4
Volcano Karimski
3 10.21.1970 11: 17 a.m. 2000 4 25 100 310 1.76 Clear weather, separate clouds
11 :00 a.m.
4 10.21.1970 11:23 a.m. 2000 5 25 100 310 1.3
11 :00 a.m.
5 10.21.1970 12 :45 p.m. 1800 5 25 100 310 0.25
I2 :38 p.m.
6 10.21.1970 12 :52 p.m. 1800 5 25 100 310 0.20
12 : 38 p.m.
7 10.21.1970 14: 46 p.m. 1700 5(9) 25 100 315 0.92
14 : 39 p.m.
~~
(continued)
TABLE11-Continued
Distance
Content of
Flight t o volcano
Serial
Date and
time of
Time of
alti- from Wind
Heli- +
SO2 H2S Content Content
measure- copter Course by of of Remarks
No. explo- tude measuring speed
sions ment point speed measuring SO2 Has
device
(m) (h/W (Whr)
8 10.23.1970 11:39a.m. 1200 2.0 20 120 290 0.2 Clear weather, separate clouds
11:27 a.m.
9 10.23.1970 11:49p.m. 1600 1.6 20 100 290 2.15
11: 45 a.m.
10 10.23.1970 11:53a.m. 1600 3.0 20 100 300 0.5
-
w
Q,
11
11: 45 a.m.
10.23.1970
12 : 53 p.m.
13 :00 p.m. 1700 1.0-1.5 20 100 290 1.75
1971
Volcano Karymski
16 10.12.1971 12: 05 p.m. 1800 4.0 40 100 230 2.0 0.98 0.25 Clear weather,
11:50a.m. separate
clouds
17 0.31 0.1
18 0.6 -
19 10.12.1971 12: 15 p.m. 2100 2.0 40 100 300 1.64 1.30 0.21
12 : 12 p.m.
20 2.15 0.25
21 0.03 0.09
22 10.12.1971 12: 34 p.m. 2100 3.0 40 100 320 4.75 1.35 0.42
12 :30 p.m.
23 4.75 0.7
24 0.24 0.2
25 0.14 0.05
26 10.15.1971 1300 25.0 40 120 340 0.04 0.04 - The train of the
10: 25 a.m. volcano floats
t o the shore
w
+ Volcano Malyi Semlyachek, crater lake
-3
27 10.15.1971 1600 0 40 100 320 0.1 0.05 -
10 : 35 a.m.
Volcano Karyrnski
10.20.1971
28 11: 43 a.m. 11: 47 a.m. 1400 2 20 120 360 - 0.32 0.01
29 11:47a.m. 11:51a.m. 1600 1.5 20 80 180 - 0.05 0.03
30 11: 47 a.m. 11:52 a.m. 1600 1.5 20 80 360 1.16 1.00 0.11
31 11:56a.m. 11:Ola.m. 1500 1.0 20 100 180 0.48 1.60 0.21
32 11: 56 a.m. 11: 03 a.m. 1500 1.5 20 100 360 3.0 1.80 0.21
33 12 :08 p.m. 12 : 11 p.m. 1700 1.5 20 100 260 0.9 0.26 0.06
34 12 :09 p.m. 12: 13 p.m. 1700 1.0 20 100 180 0.08 0.42 0.06
(continued)
TABLE
11-Continued
Distance
Content of
to volcano Heli-
Serial
Date and Time of
Flight
alti- from Wind copter
+
SOz HS2 Content Content
explo- measure- speed Course by of of Remarks
NO. tude measuring speed
sions ment point measuring SOz H2S
device
(m) (km) (WW (h/W
-
w
CD
63
10.29.1971
66 12: 41 p.m. 12 :43 p.m. 1800 1.0 8-10 100 90 7.5 3.7 2
67 12 :45 p m . 12 : 50 p.m. 1900 1.0 8-10 100 270 0.5
68 12 :05 p.m. 12 : 54 p.m. 1900 2.0 %I0 100 90 0.1? 0.03 0.04
69 12 : 51 p.m. 12 :55 p.m. 1900 0.5 8-10 100 270 O.l? 0.27 0.15
70 12: 51 p.m. 12 :57 p.m. 1900 1.0 8-10 100 90 0.1 0.49 0.02
71 13 : 05 p.m. 13 :08 p.m. 1800 1.0 8-10 100 270 1 0.05 0.03
72 13 :09 p.m. 13 : 10 p.m. I800 2.0 8-10 100 90 0.35 0.25 0.1
73 13 : 09 p.m. 13 : 12 p.m. 1800 2.0 15 100 270 0.6 0.48 0.11
74 13 : 12 p.m. 13 : 13 p.m. 1800 1.0 15 100 90 7.5 7.23 0.09
320 B. V. SHILIN AND V. B. KOMAROV
5. CONCLUSIONS
The material presented above demonstrates the following facts 1
1. New means of remote sensing of the environment, e.g. radar, infrared,
and geochemical methods, used in surveys from aircraft allow one to obtain
information which greatly improves the accuracy of our concepts of various
objects and phenomena under study. I n some cases radically new ideas are
obtained. The experience in mounting the equipment which operates in the
visible range of the spectrum, as well as the infrared receivers, on
orbital platforms permits the conclusion that information can be obtaingd
from space carriers and by means of other receivers. The method of studyine
the objects in this case is different,, as on the one hand information can be
obtained periodically while on the other hand, the studies encompass simul-
taneously enormous areas with a considerable generalization of information
due to high altitudes and small scale. I n this case, the general approach in
processing the information and its interpretation is changed. The generaliza-
tion of information on the objects under study eliminates small, particular
details and encourages the establishment of general principles in the structure
of large regions. These distinctive features of information, obtained from
satellites, require the development of new methods for interpretation with
due regard for natural connections existing between the objects on a global
scale.
2. The most comprehensive study of an object or the earth’s surface is
obtained when several types of remote sensing receivers are used in combi-
nation. An example of this process is the study of the contemporaneous
volcanism (Kamchatka) by means of radar (regional geological structure),
infrared (the structure of geothermal zones), and geochemical (gas haloes of
volcanoes and geothermal zones) surveys.
It should be noted that in all investigations using new types of remote
sensing devices they usually supplement the principal and the most
informative kind-the photographic survey.
3. For the future, the application of new types of the environmental
remote sensing studies should concentrate on development of the methodolo-
gies of surveying and of simultaneous studying the corresponding physical
parameters on the ground. This will permit more reliable interpretation of
data obtained by remote sensing for solving the specific problems dealing
with natural resources by use of aerial and satellite carriers, and will provide
a basis for developing new methods of remote sensing.
ACKNO
WLEDQMENTS
REFERENCES
Alperin, V. Z. et al. (1968). Automatic gas analyzer for continuous determination of
sulphurous gas in atmospheric air. Tr. Gl. Geofiz. Observ. No. 234.
Barringer, A. R. (1964). Proc. Symp. Remote Sensing Environ., 3rd, 1964, pp. 279-292.
Barringer, A. R., and Schork, J. R. (1966). Proc. Symp. Remote Sensing Environ., 4th,
1966, pp. 779-792.
Barringer, A. R., Newbury, B. C. and Moffat, A. J., (1968). Proc. Symp. Remote Sensing
Environ., 5th, 1968, ?p. 123-156.
Ginzburg, N. I. (1957). “An Experiment in Developing the Theoretical Principles of
Geophysical Search Methods.” Gosgeoltehizdat, Moscow.
Glushkov, V. M. et al. (1970). A new means for obtaining glaceological information.
Morsk. Plot. 99, No. 9.
Glushkov, V. M., Komarov, V. B., and Loshtshilov, V. S. (1972). Rep. Congr. I S P , 12th,-
1972, pp. 1-7.
Gussev, N. A., Karizhenski, E.Ya., and Shilin, B. V. (1972). Infrared aerial survey in
studying the regions of active geothermal activities. Sow. Geol. 1972, No. 1.
Ivanov, B. V. (1970). “Eruption of Volcano Karymski in 1962-65 and the Volcanoes of
Karymski Group.” Nauka, Moscow.
Komarov, V. B. (1971). Proc. Symp. RemoteSensing Environ., 7th, 1971, pp. 2275-2280.
Komarov, V. B., Starostin, V. A., and Nyavro, B. P. (1973). Radar aerial survey and its
significance in the complex of aerial and space methods of geological investigations.
Investigation of the natural environment by space means. Geologe and geomor-
phology. Izv. Akad. Nauk SSSR, Moscow pp. 111-119.
Manganell, R. M. (1970). Air Pollzct. Contr. 20, No. 7.
Masayo, M. (1961). Bull. Geol. Surv. Jap. 12, No. 8.
Palmason, J., and others. (1970). U S . Symp. Develop. Util. Geothem. Resour., I970
Vol. 2, Part 1.
Rouse, G. C., and Stevens, D. (1970). Mining Eng. (New Ywh)22, No. 12.
Shilin, B. V., and Berlyand M. E. (1971). Proc. Symp. Remote Sensing Environ., 7th,
1971, pp. 1733-1738.
Shilin, B. V., and others. (1969). PTOC.Symp. RemoteSensing Environ., 6th, 1969 pp. 175-
188.
Shilin, B. V., and others (1971). Proc. Symp. RemoteSensing Environ., 7th, 1971, pp. 133-
146.
Svyatlovski, A. E. (1959) “Atlas of Volcanoes of the U.S.S.R.” Izv. Akad. Nauk, SSSR,
Moscow.
Ustinova, T. I . (1955). “The Geysers of Kamchatka.” Geografgiz, Moscow.
Vinogradov, V. N. (1964). On t h e regime of Kamchatka geysers. Vop. Geogra. Kumchatki
No. 1.
SUBJECT INDEX
323
324 SUBJECT INDEX
R U
A 4
9 5
C 6
D 7
~a
F 9
G O
H I
1 2
J 3